Inform about new thread in a single place.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1823
1824 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1825 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1826 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1827 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1828 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1829 divided into four categories:
1830
1831 @table @asis
1832 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1833 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1834 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1835 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1836 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1837 the arguments.
1838 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1839 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1840 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1841
1842 @item The @emph{environment.}
1843 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1844 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1845 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1846 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1847
1848 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1849 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1850 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1851 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1854 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1855 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1856 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1857 set a different device for your program.
1858 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1859
1860 @cindex pipes
1861 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1862 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1863 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1864 wrong program.
1865 @end table
1866
1867 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1868 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1869 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1870 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1871 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1872
1873 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1874 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1875 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1876 your current breakpoints.
1877
1878 @table @code
1879 @kindex start
1880 @item start
1881 @cindex run to main procedure
1882 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1883 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1884 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1885 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1886 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1887 procedure, depending on the language used.
1888
1889 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1890 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1891 the @samp{run} command.
1892
1893 @cindex elaboration phase
1894 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1895 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1896 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1897 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1898 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1899 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1900 will remain to halt execution.
1901
1902 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1903 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1904 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1905 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1906 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1907
1908 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1909 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1910 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1911 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1912 elaboration code before running your program.
1913 @end table
1914
1915 @node Arguments
1916 @section Your Program's Arguments
1917
1918 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1919 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1920 @code{run} command.
1921 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1922 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1923 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1924 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1925 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1926
1927 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1928 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1929 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1930 the program, not by the shell.
1931
1932 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1933 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1934
1935 @table @code
1936 @kindex set args
1937 @item set args
1938 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1939 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1940 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1941 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1942 it again without arguments.
1943
1944 @kindex show args
1945 @item show args
1946 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 @node Environment
1950 @section Your Program's Environment
1951
1952 @cindex environment (of your program)
1953 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1954 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1955 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1956 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1957 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1958 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1959 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1960
1961 @table @code
1962 @kindex path
1963 @item path @var{directory}
1964 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1965 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1966 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1967 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1968 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1969 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1970 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1971
1972 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1973 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1974 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1975 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1976 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1977 @var{directory} to the search path.
1978 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1979 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1980
1981 @kindex show paths
1982 @item show paths
1983 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1984 environment variable).
1985
1986 @kindex show environment
1987 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1988 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1989 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1990 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1991 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1992
1993 @kindex set environment
1994 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1995 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1996 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1997 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1998 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1999 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2000 null value.
2001 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2002 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2003
2004 For example, this command:
2005
2006 @smallexample
2007 set env USER = foo
2008 @end smallexample
2009
2010 @noindent
2011 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2012 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2013 are not actually required.)
2014
2015 @kindex unset environment
2016 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2017 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2018 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2019 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2020 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2021 @end table
2022
2023 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2024 the shell indicated
2025 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2026 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2027 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2028 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2029 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2030 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2031 @file{.profile}.
2032
2033 @node Working Directory
2034 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2035
2036 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2037 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2038 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2039 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2040 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2041 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2042
2043 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2044 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2045 Specify Files}.
2046
2047 @table @code
2048 @kindex cd
2049 @cindex change working directory
2050 @item cd @var{directory}
2051 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2052
2053 @kindex pwd
2054 @item pwd
2055 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2056 @end table
2057
2058 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2059 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2060 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2061 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2062 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2063 current working directory of the debuggee.
2064
2065 @node Input/Output
2066 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2067
2068 @cindex redirection
2069 @cindex i/o
2070 @cindex terminal
2071 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2072 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2073 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2074 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2075 running your program.
2076
2077 @table @code
2078 @kindex info terminal
2079 @item info terminal
2080 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2081 program is using.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2085 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2086
2087 @smallexample
2088 run > outfile
2089 @end smallexample
2090
2091 @noindent
2092 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2093
2094 @kindex tty
2095 @cindex controlling terminal
2096 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2097 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2098 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2099 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2100 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2101
2102 @smallexample
2103 tty /dev/ttyb
2104 @end smallexample
2105
2106 @noindent
2107 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2108 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2109 that as their controlling terminal.
2110
2111 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2112 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2113 terminal.
2114
2115 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2116 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2117 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2118 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2119
2120 @cindex inferior tty
2121 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2122 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2123 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2124 program.
2125
2126 @table @code
2127 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2128 @kindex set inferior-tty
2129 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2130
2131 @item show inferior-tty
2132 @kindex show inferior-tty
2133 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2134 @end table
2135
2136 @node Attach
2137 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2138 @kindex attach
2139 @cindex attach
2140
2141 @table @code
2142 @item attach @var{process-id}
2143 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2144 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2145 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2146 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2147 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2148
2149 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2150 executing the command.
2151 @end table
2152
2153 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2154 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2155 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2156 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2157
2158 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2159 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2160 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2161 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2162 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2163 Specify Files}.
2164
2165 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2166 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2167 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2168 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2169 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2170 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2171 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2172
2173 @table @code
2174 @kindex detach
2175 @item detach
2176 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2177 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2178 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2179 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2180 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2181 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2182 executing the command.
2183 @end table
2184
2185 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2186 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2187 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2188 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2189 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2190 Messages}).
2191
2192 @node Kill Process
2193 @section Killing the Child Process
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @kindex kill
2197 @item kill
2198 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2202 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2203 is running.
2204
2205 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2206 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2207 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2208 outside the debugger.
2209
2210 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2211 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2212 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2213 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2214 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2215 breakpoint settings).
2216
2217 @node Threads
2218 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2219
2220 @cindex threads of execution
2221 @cindex multiple threads
2222 @cindex switching threads
2223 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2224 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2225 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2226 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2227 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2228 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2229 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2230
2231 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2232 programs:
2233
2234 @itemize @bullet
2235 @item automatic notification of new threads
2236 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2237 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2238 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2239 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2240 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2241 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2242 messages on thread start and exit.
2243 @end itemize
2244
2245 @quotation
2246 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2247 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2248 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2249 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2250 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2251 like this:
2252
2253 @smallexample
2254 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2255 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2256 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2257 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2258 @end smallexample
2259 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2260 @c doesn't support threads"?
2261 @end quotation
2262
2263 @cindex focus of debugging
2264 @cindex current thread
2265 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2266 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2267 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2268 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2269 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2270
2271 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2272 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2273 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2274 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2275 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2276 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2277 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2278 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2279 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2280 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2281
2282 @smallexample
2283 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2284 @end smallexample
2285
2286 @noindent
2287 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2288 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2289 further qualifier.
2290
2291 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2292 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2293 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2294 @c program?
2295 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2296 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2297 @c threads ab initio?
2298
2299 @cindex thread number
2300 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2301 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2302 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2303
2304 @table @code
2305 @kindex info threads
2306 @item info threads
2307 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2308 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2309
2310 @enumerate
2311 @item
2312 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2313
2314 @item
2315 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2316
2317 @item
2318 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2319 @end enumerate
2320
2321 @noindent
2322 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2323 indicates the current thread.
2324
2325 For example,
2326 @end table
2327 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2328
2329 @smallexample
2330 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2331 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2332 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2333 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2334 at threadtest.c:68
2335 @end smallexample
2336
2337 On HP-UX systems:
2338
2339 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2340 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2341 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2342 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2343 thread in your program.
2344
2345 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2346 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2347 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2348 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2349 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2350 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2351 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2352 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2353 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2354 HP-UX, you see
2355
2356 @smallexample
2357 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2358 @end smallexample
2359
2360 @noindent
2361 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2362
2363 @table @code
2364 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2365 @item info threads
2366 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2367 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2368
2369 @enumerate
2370 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2371
2372 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2373
2374 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2375 @end enumerate
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2379 indicates the current thread.
2380
2381 For example,
2382 @end table
2383 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2384
2385 @smallexample
2386 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2387 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2388 at quicksort.c:137
2389 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2390 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2391 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2392 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2393 @end smallexample
2394
2395 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2396 Solaris-specific command:
2397
2398 @table @code
2399 @item maint info sol-threads
2400 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2401 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2402 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2403 @end table
2404
2405 @table @code
2406 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2407 @item thread @var{threadno}
2408 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2409 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2410 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2411 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2412 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2413
2414 @smallexample
2415 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2416 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2417 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2418 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2419 @end smallexample
2420
2421 @noindent
2422 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2423 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2424 threads.
2425
2426 @kindex thread apply
2427 @cindex apply command to several threads
2428 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2429 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2430 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2431 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2432 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2433 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2434 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2435 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2436
2437 @kindex set print thread-events
2438 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2439 @item set print thread-events
2440 @itemx set print thread-events on
2441 @itemx set print thread-events off
2442 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2443 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2444 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2445 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2446 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2447
2448 @kindex show print thread-events
2449 @item show print thread-events
2450 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2451 have started and exited.
2452 @end table
2453
2454 @cindex automatic thread selection
2455 @cindex switching threads automatically
2456 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2457 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2458 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2459 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2460 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2461 thread.
2462
2463 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2464 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2465 programs with multiple threads.
2466
2467 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2468 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2469
2470 @node Processes
2471 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2472
2473 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2474 @cindex multiple processes
2475 @cindex processes, multiple
2476 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2477 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2478 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2479 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2480 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2481 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2482 will cause it to terminate.
2483
2484 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2485 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2486 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2487 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2488 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2489 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2490 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2491 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2492 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2493 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2494
2495 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2496 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2497 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2498 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2499
2500 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2501 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2502
2503 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2504 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2505
2506 @table @code
2507 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2508 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2509 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2510 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2511 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2512
2513 @table @code
2514 @item parent
2515 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2516 unimpeded. This is the default.
2517
2518 @item child
2519 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2520 unimpeded.
2521
2522 @end table
2523
2524 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2525 @item show follow-fork-mode
2526 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2527 @end table
2528
2529 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2530 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2531 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2532
2533 @table @code
2534 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2535 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2536 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2537 retain debugger control over them both.
2538
2539 @table @code
2540 @item on
2541 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2542 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2543 independently. This is the default.
2544
2545 @item off
2546 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2547 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2548 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2549 is held suspended.
2550
2551 @end table
2552
2553 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2554 @item show detach-on-follow
2555 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2556 @end table
2557
2558 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2559 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2560 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2561 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2562 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2563
2564 @table @code
2565 @kindex info forks
2566 @item info forks
2567 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2568 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2569 position (program counter) of the process.
2570
2571
2572 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2573 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2574 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2575 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2576 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2577
2578 @end table
2579
2580 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2581 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2582 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2583 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2584
2585 @table @code
2586 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2587 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2588 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2589 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2590 allowed to run independently.
2591
2592 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2593 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2594 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2595 and remove it from the fork list.
2596
2597 @end table
2598
2599 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2600 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2601 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2602 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2603 the child process's @code{main}.
2604
2605 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2606 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2607
2608 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2609 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2610 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2611 argument.
2612
2613 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2614 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2615 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2616
2617 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2618 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2619
2620 @cindex checkpoint
2621 @cindex restart
2622 @cindex bookmark
2623 @cindex snapshot of a process
2624 @cindex rewind program state
2625
2626 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2627 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2628 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2629 later.
2630
2631 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2632 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2633 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2634 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2635 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2636
2637 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2638 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2639 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2640 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2641 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2642 start again from there.
2643
2644 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2645 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2646
2647 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2648
2649 @table @code
2650 @kindex checkpoint
2651 @item checkpoint
2652 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2653 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2654 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2655
2656 @kindex info checkpoints
2657 @item info checkpoints
2658 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2659 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2660 listed:
2661
2662 @table @code
2663 @item Checkpoint ID
2664 @item Process ID
2665 @item Code Address
2666 @item Source line, or label
2667 @end table
2668
2669 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2670 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2671 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2672 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2673 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2674 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2675 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2676
2677 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2678 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2679 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2680 the debugger.
2681
2682 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2683 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2684 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2685
2686 @end table
2687
2688 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2689 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2690 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2691 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2692 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2693 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2694 previously read data can be read again.
2695
2696 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2697 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2698 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2699 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2700 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2701 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2702
2703 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2704 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2705 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2706 different execution path this time.
2707
2708 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2709 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2710 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2711 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2712 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2713 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2714 potentially pose a problem.
2715
2716 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2717
2718 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2719 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2720 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2721 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2722 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2723 next.
2724
2725 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2726 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2727 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2728 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2729 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2730
2731 @node Stopping
2732 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2733
2734 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2735 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2736 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2737
2738 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2739 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2740 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2741 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2742 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2743 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2744 explicitly request this information at any time.
2745
2746 @table @code
2747 @kindex info program
2748 @item info program
2749 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2750 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2751 @end table
2752
2753 @menu
2754 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2755 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2756 * Signals:: Signals
2757 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2758 @end menu
2759
2760 @node Breakpoints
2761 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2762
2763 @cindex breakpoints
2764 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2765 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2766 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2767 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2768 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2769 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2770 program.
2771
2772 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2773 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2774 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2775 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2776 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2777 call).
2778
2779 @cindex watchpoints
2780 @cindex data breakpoints
2781 @cindex memory tracing
2782 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2783 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2784 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2785 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2786 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2787 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2788 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2789 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2790 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2791 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2792 same commands.
2793
2794 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2795 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2796 Automatic Display}.
2797
2798 @cindex catchpoints
2799 @cindex breakpoint on events
2800 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2801 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2802 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2803 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2804 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2805 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2806 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2807
2808 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2809 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2810 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2811 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2812 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2813 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2814 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2815 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2816 enable it again.
2817
2818 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2819 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2820 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2821 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2822 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2823 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2824 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2825
2826 @menu
2827 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2828 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2829 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2830 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2831 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2832 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2833 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2834 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2835 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2836 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2837 @end menu
2838
2839 @node Set Breaks
2840 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2841
2842 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2843 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2844 @c
2845 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2846
2847 @kindex break
2848 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2849 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2850 @cindex latest breakpoint
2851 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2852 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2853 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2854 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2855 convenience variables.
2856
2857 @table @code
2858 @item break @var{location}
2859 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2860 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2861 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2862 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2863 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2864
2865 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2866 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2867 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2868
2869 @item break
2870 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2871 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2872 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2873 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2874 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2875 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2876 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2877 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2878 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2879 inside loops.
2880
2881 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2882 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2883 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2884 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2885 existed when your program stopped.
2886
2887 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2888 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2889 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2890 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2891 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2892 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2893 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2894
2895 @kindex tbreak
2896 @item tbreak @var{args}
2897 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2898 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2899 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2900 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2901
2902 @kindex hbreak
2903 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2904 @item hbreak @var{args}
2905 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2906 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2907 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2908 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2909 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2910 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2911 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2912 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2913 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2914 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2915 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2916 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2917 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2918 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2919 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2920 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2921 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2922 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2923
2924 @kindex thbreak
2925 @item thbreak @var{args}
2926 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2927 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2928 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2929 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2930 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2931 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2932 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2933 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2934
2935 @kindex rbreak
2936 @cindex regular expression
2937 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2938 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2939 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2940 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2941 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2942 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2943 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2944 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2945 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2946
2947 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2948 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2949 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2950 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2951 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2952 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2953
2954 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2955 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2956 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2957 classes.
2958
2959 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2960 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2961 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2962
2963 @smallexample
2964 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2965 @end smallexample
2966
2967 @kindex info breakpoints
2968 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2969 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2970 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2971 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2972 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2973 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2974 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2975 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2976
2977 @table @emph
2978 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2979 @item Type
2980 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2981 @item Disposition
2982 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2983 @item Enabled or Disabled
2984 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2985 that are not enabled. An optional @samp{(p)} suffix marks pending
2986 breakpoints---breakpoints for which address is either not yet
2987 resolved, pending load of a shared library, or for which address was
2988 in a shared library that was since unloaded. Such breakpoint won't
2989 fire until a shared library that has the symbol or line referred by
2990 breakpoint is loaded. See below for details.
2991 @item Address
2992 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
2993 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
2994 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. A breakpoint with several locations will
2995 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
2996 @item What
2997 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2998 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2999 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3000 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3001 @end table
3002
3003 @noindent
3004 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3005 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3006 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3007 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3008 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3009 valid location.
3010
3011 @noindent
3012 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3013 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3014 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3015 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3016 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3017
3018 @noindent
3019 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3020 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3021 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3022 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3023 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3024 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3025 @end table
3026
3027 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3028 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3029 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3030 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3031
3032 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3033 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3034
3035 @itemize @bullet
3036
3037 @item
3038 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3039 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3040
3041 @item
3042 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3043 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3044
3045 @item
3046 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3047 several places where that function is inlined.
3048
3049 @end itemize
3050
3051 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3052 the relevant locations.
3053
3054 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3055 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3056 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3057 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3058 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3059 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3060 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3061
3062 For example:
3063
3064 @smallexample
3065 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3066 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3067 stop only if i==1
3068 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3069 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3070 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3074 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3075 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3076 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3077 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3078 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3079 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3080 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3081 that belong to that breakpoint.
3082
3083 @cindex pending breakpoints
3084 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3085 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3086 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3087 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3088 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3089 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3090 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3091 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3092 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3093 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3094 is not yet resolved.
3095
3096 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3097 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3098 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3099 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3100 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3101 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3102
3103 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3104 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3105 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3106 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3107
3108 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3109 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3110 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3111
3112 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3113 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3114 address specification to an address:
3115
3116 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3117 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3118 @table @code
3119 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3120 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3121 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3122
3123 @item set breakpoint pending on
3124 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3125 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3126
3127 @item set breakpoint pending off
3128 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3129 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3130 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3131
3132 @item show breakpoint pending
3133 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3134 @end table
3135
3136 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3137 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3138 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3139
3140 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3141 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3142 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3143 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3144 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3145 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3146 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3147 breakpoints.
3148
3149 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3150
3151 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3152 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3153 @table @code
3154 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3155 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3156 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3157 breakpoint must be used.
3158
3159 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3160 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3161 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3162 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3163 @end table
3164
3165
3166 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3167 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3168 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3169 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3170 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3171 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3172 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3173 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3174
3175
3176 @node Set Watchpoints
3177 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3178
3179 @cindex setting watchpoints
3180 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3181 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3182 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3183 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3184 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3185
3186 @itemize @bullet
3187 @item
3188 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3189
3190 @item
3191 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3192 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3193 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3194
3195 @item
3196 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3197 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3198 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3199 @end itemize
3200
3201 @cindex software watchpoints
3202 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3203 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3204 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3205 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3206 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3207 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3208 culprit.)
3209
3210 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3211 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3212 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3213
3214 @table @code
3215 @kindex watch
3216 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3217 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3218 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3219 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3220 to watch the value of a single variable:
3221
3222 @smallexample
3223 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3224 @end smallexample
3225
3226 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3227 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3228 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3229 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3230 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3231 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3232
3233 @kindex rwatch
3234 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3235 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3236 by the program.
3237
3238 @kindex awatch
3239 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3240 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3241 or written into by the program.
3242
3243 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3244 @item info watchpoints
3245 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3246 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3247 @end table
3248
3249 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3250 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3251 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3252 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3253 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3254 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3255
3256 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3257 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3258 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3259 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3260 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3261 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3262 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3263 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3264
3265 @table @code
3266 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3267 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3268 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3269
3270 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3271 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3272 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3273 @end table
3274
3275 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3276 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3277 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3278
3279 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3280
3281 @smallexample
3282 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3283 @end smallexample
3284
3285 @noindent
3286 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3287
3288 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3289 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3290 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3291 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3292 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3293 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3294 will print a message like this:
3295
3296 @smallexample
3297 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3298 @end smallexample
3299
3300 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3301 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3302 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3303 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3304 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3305 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3306 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3307 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3308
3309 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3310 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3311 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3312 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3313 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3314 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3315
3316 @smallexample
3317 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3318 @end smallexample
3319
3320 @noindent
3321 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3322
3323 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3324 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3325 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3326 expression with separately allocated resources.
3327
3328 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3329 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3330 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3331 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3332 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3333 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3334 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3335 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3336 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3337 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3338
3339 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3340 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3341 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3342
3343 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3344 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3345 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3346 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3347 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3348 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3349 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3350 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3351 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3352
3353 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3354 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3355 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3356 watched expression from every thread.
3357
3358 @quotation
3359 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3360 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3361 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3362 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3363 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3364 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3365 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3366 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3367 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3368 @end quotation
3369
3370 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3371
3372 @node Set Catchpoints
3373 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3374 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3375 @cindex exception handlers
3376 @cindex event handling
3377
3378 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3379 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3380 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3381
3382 @table @code
3383 @kindex catch
3384 @item catch @var{event}
3385 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3386 @table @code
3387 @item throw
3388 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3389 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3390
3391 @item catch
3392 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3393
3394 @item exception
3395 @cindex Ada exception catching
3396 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3397 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3398 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3399 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3400 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3401
3402 @item exception unhandled
3403 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3404
3405 @item assert
3406 A failed Ada assertion.
3407
3408 @item exec
3409 @cindex break on fork/exec
3410 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3411
3412 @item fork
3413 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3414
3415 @item vfork
3416 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3417
3418 @item load
3419 @itemx load @var{libname}
3420 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3421 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3422 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3423
3424 @item unload
3425 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3426 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3427 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3428 @end table
3429
3430 @item tcatch @var{event}
3431 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3432 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3433
3434 @end table
3435
3436 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3437
3438 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3439 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3440
3441 @itemize @bullet
3442 @item
3443 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3444 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3445 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3446 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3447 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3448 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3449 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3450 disabled within interactive calls.
3451
3452 @item
3453 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3454
3455 @item
3456 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3457 @end itemize
3458
3459 @cindex raise exceptions
3460 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3461 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3462 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3463 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3464 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3465 out where the exception was raised.
3466
3467 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3468 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3469 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3470 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3471
3472 @smallexample
3473 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3474 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3475 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3476 @end smallexample
3477
3478 @noindent
3479 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3480 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3481 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3482
3483 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3484 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3485 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3486 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3487 raised.
3488
3489
3490 @node Delete Breaks
3491 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3492
3493 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3494 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3495 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3496 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3497 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3498 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3499
3500 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3501 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3502 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3503 their breakpoint numbers.
3504
3505 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3506 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3507 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3508
3509 @table @code
3510 @kindex clear
3511 @item clear
3512 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3513 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3514 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3515 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3516
3517 @item clear @var{location}
3518 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3519 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3520 most useful ones are listed below:
3521
3522 @table @code
3523 @item clear @var{function}
3524 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3525 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3526
3527 @item clear @var{linenum}
3528 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3529 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3530 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3531 @end table
3532
3533 @cindex delete breakpoints
3534 @kindex delete
3535 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3536 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3537 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3538 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3539 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3540 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3541 @end table
3542
3543 @node Disabling
3544 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3545
3546 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3547 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3548 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3549 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3550 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3551
3552 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3553 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3554 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3555 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3556 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3557
3558 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3559 affects all of its locations.
3560
3561 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3562 states of enablement:
3563
3564 @itemize @bullet
3565 @item
3566 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3567 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3568 @item
3569 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3570 @item
3571 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3572 disabled.
3573 @item
3574 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3575 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3576 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3577 @end itemize
3578
3579 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3580 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3581
3582 @table @code
3583 @kindex disable
3584 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3585 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3586 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3587 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3588 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3589 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3590 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3591
3592 @kindex enable
3593 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3594 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3595 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3596
3597 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3598 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3599 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3600
3601 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3602 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3603 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3604 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3605 @end table
3606
3607 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3608 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3609 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3610 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3611 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3612 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3613 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3614 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3615 Stepping}.)
3616
3617 @node Conditions
3618 @subsection Break Conditions
3619 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3620 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3621
3622 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3623 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3624 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3625 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3626 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3627 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3628 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3629 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3630
3631 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3632 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3633 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3634 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3635 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3636
3637 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3638 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3639 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3640 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3641 one.
3642
3643 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3644 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3645 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3646 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3647 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3648 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3649 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3650 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3651 conditions for the
3652 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3653 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3654
3655 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3656 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3657 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3658 with the @code{condition} command.
3659
3660 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3661 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3662 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3663 catchpoint.
3664
3665 @table @code
3666 @kindex condition
3667 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3668 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3669 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3670 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3671 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3672 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3673 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3674 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3675 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3676 prints an error message:
3677
3678 @smallexample
3679 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3680 @end smallexample
3681
3682 @noindent
3683 @value{GDBN} does
3684 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3685 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3686 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3687
3688 @item condition @var{bnum}
3689 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3690 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3691 @end table
3692
3693 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3694 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3695 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3696 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3697 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3698 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3699 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3700 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3701 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3702 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3703 your program reaches it.
3704
3705 @table @code
3706 @kindex ignore
3707 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3708 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3709 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3710 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3711 takes no action.
3712
3713 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3714 a count of zero.
3715
3716 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3717 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3718 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3719 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3720
3721 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3722 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3723 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3724
3725 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3726 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3727 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3728 Variables}.
3729 @end table
3730
3731 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3732
3733
3734 @node Break Commands
3735 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3736
3737 @cindex breakpoint commands
3738 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3739 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3740 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3741 enable other breakpoints.
3742
3743 @table @code
3744 @kindex commands
3745 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3746 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3747 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3748 @itemx end
3749 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3750 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3751 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3752
3753 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3754 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3755
3756 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3757 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3758 recently encountered).
3759 @end table
3760
3761 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3762 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3763
3764 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3765 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3766 that resumes execution.
3767
3768 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3769 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3770 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3771 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3772 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3773
3774 @kindex silent
3775 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3776 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3777 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3778 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3779 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3780 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3781
3782 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3783 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3784 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3785
3786 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3787 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3788
3789 @smallexample
3790 break foo if x>0
3791 commands
3792 silent
3793 printf "x is %d\n",x
3794 cont
3795 end
3796 @end smallexample
3797
3798 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3799 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3800 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3801 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3802 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3803 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3804 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3805
3806 @smallexample
3807 break 403
3808 commands
3809 silent
3810 set x = y + 4
3811 cont
3812 end
3813 @end smallexample
3814
3815 @node Breakpoint Menus
3816 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3817 @cindex overloading
3818 @cindex symbol overloading
3819
3820 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3821 single function name
3822 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3823 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3824 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3825 a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3826 @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3827 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3828 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3829 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3830 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3831 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3832 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3833 breakpoints.
3834
3835 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3836 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3837 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3838
3839 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3840 @smallexample
3841 @group
3842 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3843 [0] cancel
3844 [1] all
3845 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3846 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3847 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3848 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3849 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3850 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3851 > 2 4 6
3852 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3853 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3854 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3855 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3856 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3857 breakpoints.
3858 (@value{GDBP})
3859 @end group
3860 @end smallexample
3861
3862 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3863 @node Error in Breakpoints
3864 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3865 @c
3866 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3867 @c
3868 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3869 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3870 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3871 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3872
3873 @smallexample
3874 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3875 The same program may be running in another process.
3876 @end smallexample
3877
3878 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3879
3880 @enumerate
3881 @item
3882 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3883
3884 @item
3885 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3886 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3887 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3888 Then start your program again.
3889
3890 @item
3891 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3892 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3893 to nonsharable executables.
3894 @end enumerate
3895 @c @end ifclear
3896
3897 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3898 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3899
3900 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3901 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3902 @smallexample
3903 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3904 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3905 @end smallexample
3906
3907 @noindent
3908 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3909 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3910 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3911
3912 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3913 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3914
3915 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3916 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3917 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3918
3919 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3920 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3921 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3922 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3923
3924 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3925 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3926 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3927 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3928 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3929 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3930 first in the bundle.
3931
3932 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3933 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3934 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3935 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3936 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3937 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3938 is hit.
3939
3940 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3941 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3942
3943 @smallexample
3944 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3945 @end smallexample
3946
3947 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3948 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3949 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3950 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3951 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3952 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3953 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3954 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3955
3956 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3957 adjusted breakpoints:
3958
3959 @smallexample
3960 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3961 to 0x00010410.
3962 @end smallexample
3963
3964 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3965 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3966 frequently than expected.
3967
3968 @node Continuing and Stepping
3969 @section Continuing and Stepping
3970
3971 @cindex stepping
3972 @cindex continuing
3973 @cindex resuming execution
3974 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3975 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3976 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3977 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3978 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3979 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3980 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3981 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3982
3983 @table @code
3984 @kindex continue
3985 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3986 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3987 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3988 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3989 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3990 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3991 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3992 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3993 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3994 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3995
3996 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3997 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3998 @code{continue} is ignored.
3999
4000 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4001 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4002 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4003 @code{continue}.
4004 @end table
4005
4006 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4007 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4008 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4009 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4010
4011 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4012 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4013 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4014 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4015 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4016 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4017
4018 @table @code
4019 @kindex step
4020 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4021 @item step
4022 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4023 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4024 abbreviated @code{s}.
4025
4026 @quotation
4027 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4028 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4029 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4030 @c distinction here.
4031 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4032 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4033 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4034 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4035 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4036 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4037 below.
4038 @end quotation
4039
4040 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4041 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4042 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4043 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4044 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4045 called within the line.
4046
4047 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4048 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4049 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4050 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4051 was any debugging information about the routine.
4052
4053 @item step @var{count}
4054 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4055 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4056 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4057
4058 @kindex next
4059 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4060 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4061 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4062 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4063 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4064 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4065 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4066 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4067
4068 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4069
4070
4071 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4072 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4073 @c
4074 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4075 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4076 @c function are executed without stopping.
4077
4078 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4079 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4080 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4081
4082 @kindex set step-mode
4083 @item set step-mode
4084 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4085 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4086 @itemx set step-mode on
4087 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4088 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4089 information rather than stepping over it.
4090
4091 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4092 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4093 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4094
4095 @item set step-mode off
4096 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4097 debug information. This is the default.
4098
4099 @item show step-mode
4100 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4101 source line debug information.
4102
4103 @kindex finish
4104 @item finish
4105 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4106 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4107
4108 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4109 ,Returning from a Function}).
4110
4111 @kindex until
4112 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4113 @cindex run until specified location
4114 @item until
4115 @itemx u
4116 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4117 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4118 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4119 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4120 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4121 than the address of the jump.
4122
4123 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4124 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4125 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4126 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4127 through the next iteration.
4128
4129 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4130 stack frame.
4131
4132 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4133 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4134 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4135 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4136 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4137
4138 @smallexample
4139 (@value{GDBP}) f
4140 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4141 206 expand_input();
4142 (@value{GDBP}) until
4143 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4144 @end smallexample
4145
4146 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4147 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4148 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4149 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4150 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4151 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4152 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4153
4154 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4155 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4156 argument.
4157
4158 @item until @var{location}
4159 @itemx u @var{location}
4160 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4161 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4162 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4163 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4164 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4165 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4166 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4167 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4168 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4169 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4170 invocations have returned.
4171
4172 @smallexample
4173 94 int factorial (int value)
4174 95 @{
4175 96 if (value > 1) @{
4176 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4177 98 @}
4178 99 return (value);
4179 100 @}
4180 @end smallexample
4181
4182
4183 @kindex advance @var{location}
4184 @itemx advance @var{location}
4185 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4186 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4187 @ref{Specify Location}.
4188 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4189 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4190 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4191 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4192
4193
4194 @kindex stepi
4195 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4196 @item stepi
4197 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4198 @itemx si
4199 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4200
4201 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4202 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4203 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4204 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4205
4206 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4207
4208 @need 750
4209 @kindex nexti
4210 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4211 @item nexti
4212 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4213 @itemx ni
4214 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4215 proceed until the function returns.
4216
4217 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4218 @end table
4219
4220 @node Signals
4221 @section Signals
4222 @cindex signals
4223
4224 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4225 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4226 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4227 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4228 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4229 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4230 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4231 requested an alarm).
4232
4233 @cindex fatal signals
4234 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4235 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4236 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4237 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4238 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4239 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4240
4241 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4242 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4243 signal.
4244
4245 @cindex handling signals
4246 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4247 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4248 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4249 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4250 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4251
4252 @table @code
4253 @kindex info signals
4254 @kindex info handle
4255 @item info signals
4256 @itemx info handle
4257 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4258 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4259 the defined types of signals.
4260
4261 @item info signals @var{sig}
4262 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4263
4264 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4265
4266 @kindex handle
4267 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4268 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4269 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4270 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4271 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4272 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4273 say what change to make.
4274 @end table
4275
4276 @c @group
4277 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4278 Their full names are:
4279
4280 @table @code
4281 @item nostop
4282 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4283 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4284
4285 @item stop
4286 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4287 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4288
4289 @item print
4290 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4291
4292 @item noprint
4293 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4294 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4295
4296 @item pass
4297 @itemx noignore
4298 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4299 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4300 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4301
4302 @item nopass
4303 @itemx ignore
4304 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4305 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4306 @end table
4307 @c @end group
4308
4309 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4310 program until you
4311 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4312 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4313 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4314 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4315 program sees that signal when you continue.
4316
4317 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4318 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4319 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4320 erroneous signals.
4321
4322 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4323 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4324 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4325 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4326 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4327 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4328 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4329 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4330 Program a Signal}.
4331
4332 @node Thread Stops
4333 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4334
4335 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4336 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4337 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4338
4339 @table @code
4340 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4341 @cindex thread breakpoints
4342 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4343 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4344 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4345 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4346 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4347 specify some source line.
4348
4349 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4350 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4351 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4352 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4353 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4354
4355 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4356 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4357 program.
4358
4359 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4360 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4361 breakpoint condition, like this:
4362
4363 @smallexample
4364 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4365 @end smallexample
4366
4367 @end table
4368
4369 @cindex stopped threads
4370 @cindex threads, stopped
4371 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4372 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4373 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4374 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4375 underfoot.
4376
4377 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4378 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4379 @cindex premature return from system calls
4380 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4381 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4382 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4383 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4384 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4385 stop execution.
4386
4387 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4388 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4389 style anyways.
4390
4391 For example, do not write code like this:
4392
4393 @smallexample
4394 sleep (10);
4395 @end smallexample
4396
4397 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4398 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4399
4400 Instead, write this:
4401
4402 @smallexample
4403 int unslept = 10;
4404 while (unslept > 0)
4405 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4406 @end smallexample
4407
4408 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4409 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4410 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4411 @value{GDBN}.
4412
4413 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4414 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4415 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4416 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4417
4418 @cindex continuing threads
4419 @cindex threads, continuing
4420 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4421 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4422 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4423
4424 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4425 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4426 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4427 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4428 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4429 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4430 stops.
4431
4432 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4433 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4434 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4435 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4436
4437 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4438 thread to run.
4439
4440 @table @code
4441 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4442 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4443 @cindex lock scheduler
4444 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4445 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4446 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4447 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4448 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4449 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4450 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4451 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4452 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4453 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4454 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4455
4456 @item show scheduler-locking
4457 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4458 @end table
4459
4460
4461 @node Stack
4462 @chapter Examining the Stack
4463
4464 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4465 stopped and how it got there.
4466
4467 @cindex call stack
4468 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4469 is generated.
4470 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4471 the arguments of the call,
4472 and the local variables of the function being called.
4473 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4474 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4475 stack}.
4476
4477 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4478 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4479
4480 @cindex selected frame
4481 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4482 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4483 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4484 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4485 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4486 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4487
4488 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4489 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4490 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4491
4492 @menu
4493 * Frames:: Stack frames
4494 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4495 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4496 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4497
4498 @end menu
4499
4500 @node Frames
4501 @section Stack Frames
4502
4503 @cindex frame, definition
4504 @cindex stack frame
4505 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4506 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4507 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4508 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4509 which the function is executing.
4510
4511 @cindex initial frame
4512 @cindex outermost frame
4513 @cindex innermost frame
4514 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4515 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4516 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4517 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4518 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4519 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4520 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4521 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4522
4523 @cindex frame pointer
4524 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4525 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4526 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4527 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4528 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4529 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4530
4531 @cindex frame number
4532 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4533 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4534 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4535 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4536 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4537
4538 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4539 @c underflow problems.
4540 @cindex frameless execution
4541 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4542 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4543 @smallexample
4544 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4545 @end smallexample
4546 generates functions without a frame.)
4547 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4548 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4549 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4550 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4551 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4552 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4553 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4554
4555 @table @code
4556 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4557 @cindex current stack frame
4558 @item frame @var{args}
4559 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4560 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4561 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4562 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4563
4564 @kindex select-frame
4565 @cindex selecting frame silently
4566 @item select-frame
4567 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4568 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4569 @code{frame}.
4570 @end table
4571
4572 @node Backtrace
4573 @section Backtraces
4574
4575 @cindex traceback
4576 @cindex call stack traces
4577 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4578 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4579 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4580 stack.
4581
4582 @table @code
4583 @kindex backtrace
4584 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4585 @item backtrace
4586 @itemx bt
4587 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4588 frames in the stack.
4589
4590 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4591 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4592
4593 @item backtrace @var{n}
4594 @itemx bt @var{n}
4595 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4596
4597 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4598 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4599 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4600
4601 @item backtrace full
4602 @itemx bt full
4603 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4604 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4605 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4606 number of frames to print, as described above.
4607 @end table
4608
4609 @kindex where
4610 @kindex info stack
4611 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4612 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4613
4614 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4615 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4616 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4617 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4618 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4619 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4620 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4621 multi-threaded program.
4622
4623 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4624 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4625 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4626 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4627 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4628 line number.
4629
4630 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4631 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4632
4633 @smallexample
4634 @group
4635 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4636 at builtin.c:993
4637 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4638 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4639 at macro.c:71
4640 (More stack frames follow...)
4641 @end group
4642 @end smallexample
4643
4644 @noindent
4645 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4646 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4647 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4648
4649 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4650 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4651 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4652 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4653 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4654 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4655 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4656 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4657 such a backtrace might look like:
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 @group
4661 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4662 at builtin.c:993
4663 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4664 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4665 at macro.c:71
4666 (More stack frames follow...)
4667 @end group
4668 @end smallexample
4669
4670 @noindent
4671 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4672 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4673
4674 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4675 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4676 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4677
4678 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4679 @cindex program entry point
4680 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4681 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4682 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4683 @code{main}@footnote{
4684 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4685 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4686 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4687 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4688 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4689 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4690
4691 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4692 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4693
4694 @table @code
4695 @item set backtrace past-main
4696 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4697 @kindex set backtrace
4698 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4699
4700 @item set backtrace past-main off
4701 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4702 default.
4703
4704 @item show backtrace past-main
4705 @kindex show backtrace
4706 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4707
4708 @item set backtrace past-entry
4709 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4710 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4711 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4712 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4713
4714 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4715 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4716 application. This is the default.
4717
4718 @item show backtrace past-entry
4719 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4720
4721 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4722 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4723 @cindex backtrace limit
4724 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4725 unlimited.
4726
4727 @item show backtrace limit
4728 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4729 @end table
4730
4731 @node Selection
4732 @section Selecting a Frame
4733
4734 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4735 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4736 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4737 of the stack frame just selected.
4738
4739 @table @code
4740 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4741 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4742 @item frame @var{n}
4743 @itemx f @var{n}
4744 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4745 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4746 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4747 @code{main}.
4748
4749 @item frame @var{addr}
4750 @itemx f @var{addr}
4751 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4752 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4753 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4754 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4755 switches between them.
4756
4757 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4758 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4759
4760 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4761 pointer and a program counter.
4762
4763 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4764 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4765
4766 @kindex up
4767 @item up @var{n}
4768 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4769 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4770 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4771
4772 @kindex down
4773 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4774 @item down @var{n}
4775 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4776 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4777 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4778 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4779 @end table
4780
4781 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4782 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4783 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4784 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4785
4786 @need 1000
4787 For example:
4788
4789 @smallexample
4790 @group
4791 (@value{GDBP}) up
4792 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4793 at env.c:10
4794 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4795 @end group
4796 @end smallexample
4797
4798 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4799 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4800 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4801 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4802 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4803 for details.
4804
4805 @table @code
4806 @kindex down-silently
4807 @kindex up-silently
4808 @item up-silently @var{n}
4809 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4810 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4811 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4812 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4813 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4814 distracting.
4815 @end table
4816
4817 @node Frame Info
4818 @section Information About a Frame
4819
4820 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4821 stack frame.
4822
4823 @table @code
4824 @item frame
4825 @itemx f
4826 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4827 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4828 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4829 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4830 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4831
4832 @kindex info frame
4833 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4834 @item info frame
4835 @itemx info f
4836 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4837 including:
4838
4839 @itemize @bullet
4840 @item
4841 the address of the frame
4842 @item
4843 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4844 @item
4845 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4846 @item
4847 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4848 @item
4849 the address of the frame's arguments
4850 @item
4851 the address of the frame's local variables
4852 @item
4853 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4854 @item
4855 which registers were saved in the frame
4856 @end itemize
4857
4858 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4859 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4860 the usual conventions.
4861
4862 @item info frame @var{addr}
4863 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4864 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4865 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4866 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4867 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4868 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4869
4870 @kindex info args
4871 @item info args
4872 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4873
4874 @item info locals
4875 @kindex info locals
4876 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4877 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4878 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4879
4880 @kindex info catch
4881 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4882 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4883 @item info catch
4884 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4885 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4886 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4887 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4888 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4889
4890 @end table
4891
4892
4893 @node Source
4894 @chapter Examining Source Files
4895
4896 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4897 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4898 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4899 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4900 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4901 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4902 source files by explicit command.
4903
4904 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4905 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4906 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4907
4908 @menu
4909 * List:: Printing source lines
4910 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4911 * Edit:: Editing source files
4912 * Search:: Searching source files
4913 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4914 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4915 @end menu
4916
4917 @node List
4918 @section Printing Source Lines
4919
4920 @kindex list
4921 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4922 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4923 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4924 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4925 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4926
4927 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4928
4929 @table @code
4930 @item list @var{linenum}
4931 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4932 current source file.
4933
4934 @item list @var{function}
4935 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4936 @var{function}.
4937
4938 @item list
4939 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4940 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4941 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4942 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4943 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4944
4945 @item list -
4946 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4947 @end table
4948
4949 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4950 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4951 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4952
4953 @table @code
4954 @kindex set listsize
4955 @item set listsize @var{count}
4956 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4957 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4958
4959 @kindex show listsize
4960 @item show listsize
4961 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4962 @end table
4963
4964 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4965 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4966 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4967 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4968 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4969
4970 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4971 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4972 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
4973 to specify some source line.
4974
4975 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4976
4977 @table @code
4978 @item list @var{linespec}
4979 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4980
4981 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4982 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4983 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
4984 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
4985 the same source file as the first linespec.
4986
4987 @item list ,@var{last}
4988 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4989
4990 @item list @var{first},
4991 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4992
4993 @item list +
4994 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4995
4996 @item list -
4997 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4998
4999 @item list
5000 As described in the preceding table.
5001 @end table
5002
5003 @node Specify Location
5004 @section Specifying a Location
5005 @cindex specifying location
5006 @cindex linespec
5007
5008 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5009 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5010 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5011 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5012
5013 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5014 @value{GDBN} understands:
5015
5016 @table @code
5017 @item @var{linenum}
5018 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5019
5020 @item -@var{offset}
5021 @itemx +@var{offset}
5022 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5023 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5024 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5025 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5026 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5027 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5028 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5029 linespec.
5030
5031 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5032 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5033
5034 @item @var{function}
5035 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5036 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5037
5038 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5039 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5040 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5041 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5042 functions in different source files.
5043
5044 @item *@var{address}
5045 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5046 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5047 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5048 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5049 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5050 source files.
5051
5052 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5053 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5054 address. As a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the semantics of
5055 expressions used in locations to cover the situations that frequently
5056 happen during debugging. Here are the various forms of @var{address}:
5057
5058 @table @code
5059 @item @var{expression}
5060 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5061
5062 @item @var{funcaddr}
5063 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5064 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5065 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5066 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5067 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5068 (although the Pascal form also works).
5069
5070 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5071 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5072
5073 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5074 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5075 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5076 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5077 functions with identical names in different source files.
5078 @end table
5079
5080 @end table
5081
5082
5083 @node Edit
5084 @section Editing Source Files
5085 @cindex editing source files
5086
5087 @kindex edit
5088 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5089 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5090 The editing program of your choice
5091 is invoked with the current line set to
5092 the active line in the program.
5093 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5094 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5095
5096 @table @code
5097 @item edit @var{location}
5098 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5099 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5100 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5101 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5102 command most commonly used:
5103
5104 @table @code
5105 @item edit @var{number}
5106 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5107
5108 @item edit @var{function}
5109 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5110 @end table
5111
5112 @end table
5113
5114 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5115 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5116 @footnote{
5117 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5118 following command-line syntax:
5119 @smallexample
5120 ex +@var{number} file
5121 @end smallexample
5122 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5123 the file where to start editing.}.
5124 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5125 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5126 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5127 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5128 @smallexample
5129 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5130 export EDITOR
5131 gdb @dots{}
5132 @end smallexample
5133 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5134 @smallexample
5135 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5136 gdb @dots{}
5137 @end smallexample
5138
5139 @node Search
5140 @section Searching Source Files
5141 @cindex searching source files
5142
5143 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5144 regular expression.
5145
5146 @table @code
5147 @kindex search
5148 @kindex forward-search
5149 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5150 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5151 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5152 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5153 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5154 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5155 @code{fo}.
5156
5157 @kindex reverse-search
5158 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5159 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5160 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5161 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5162 this command as @code{rev}.
5163 @end table
5164
5165 @node Source Path
5166 @section Specifying Source Directories
5167
5168 @cindex source path
5169 @cindex directories for source files
5170 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5171 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5172 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5173 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5174 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5175 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5176 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5177
5178 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5179 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5180 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5181 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5182 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5183 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5184 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5185 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5186 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5187 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5188 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5189
5190 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5191 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5192 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5193 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5194 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5195 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5196
5197 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5198 source files.
5199
5200 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5201 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5202 each line is in the file.
5203
5204 @kindex directory
5205 @kindex dir
5206 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5207 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5208 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5209
5210 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5211 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5212
5213 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5214 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5215 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5216 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5217 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5218 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5219 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5220 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5221 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5222 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5223 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5224 name to look up the sources.
5225
5226 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5227 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5228 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5229 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5230 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5231 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5232 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5233 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5234
5235 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5236 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5237 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5238 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5239 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5240 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5241 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5242
5243 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5244 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5245 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5246 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5247 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5248 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5249 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5250 command.
5251
5252 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5253 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5254 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5255 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5256 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5257 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5258 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5259
5260 @table @code
5261 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5262 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5263 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5264 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5265 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5266 part of absolute file names) or
5267 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5268 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5269
5270 @kindex cdir
5271 @kindex cwd
5272 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5273 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5274 @cindex compilation directory
5275 @cindex current directory
5276 @cindex working directory
5277 @cindex directory, current
5278 @cindex directory, compilation
5279 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5280 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5281 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5282 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5283 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5284 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5285
5286 @item directory
5287 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5288
5289 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5290 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5291
5292 @item show directories
5293 @kindex show directories
5294 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5295
5296 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5297 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5298 @kindex set substitute-path
5299 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5300 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5301 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5302
5303 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5304 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5305
5306 @smallexample
5307 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5308 @end smallexample
5309
5310 @noindent
5311 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5312 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5313 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5314
5315 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5316 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5317 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5318 the substitution.
5319
5320 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5321
5322 @smallexample
5323 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5324 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 @noindent
5328 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5329 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5330 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5331 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5332
5333
5334 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5335 @kindex unset substitute-path
5336 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5337 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5338 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5339
5340 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5341
5342 @item show substitute-path [path]
5343 @kindex show substitute-path
5344 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5345 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5346
5347 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5348 rules.
5349
5350 @end table
5351
5352 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5353 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5354 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5355
5356 @enumerate
5357 @item
5358 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5359
5360 @item
5361 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5362 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5363 directories in one command.
5364 @end enumerate
5365
5366 @node Machine Code
5367 @section Source and Machine Code
5368 @cindex source line and its code address
5369
5370 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5371 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5372 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5373 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5374 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5375 well as hex.
5376
5377 @table @code
5378 @kindex info line
5379 @item info line @var{linespec}
5380 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5381 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5382 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5383 @end table
5384
5385 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5386 the object code for the first line of function
5387 @code{m4_changequote}:
5388
5389 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5390 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5391 @smallexample
5392 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5393 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5394 @end smallexample
5395
5396 @noindent
5397 @cindex code address and its source line
5398 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5399 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5400 @smallexample
5401 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5402 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5403 @end smallexample
5404
5405 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5406 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5407 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5408 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5409 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5410 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5411 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5412 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5413 Variables}).
5414
5415 @table @code
5416 @kindex disassemble
5417 @cindex assembly instructions
5418 @cindex instructions, assembly
5419 @cindex machine instructions
5420 @cindex listing machine instructions
5421 @item disassemble
5422 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5423 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5424 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5425 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5426 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5427 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5428 @end table
5429
5430 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5431 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5432
5433 @smallexample
5434 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5435 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5436 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5437 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5438 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5439 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5440 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5441 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5442 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5443 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5444 End of assembler dump.
5445 @end smallexample
5446
5447 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5448 mnemonics or other syntax.
5449
5450 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5451 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5452 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5453 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5454 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5455
5456 @table @code
5457 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5458 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5459 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5460 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5461 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5462 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5463
5464 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5465 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5466 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5467 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5468
5469 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5470 @item show disassembly-flavor
5471 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5472 @end table
5473
5474
5475 @node Data
5476 @chapter Examining Data
5477
5478 @cindex printing data
5479 @cindex examining data
5480 @kindex print
5481 @kindex inspect
5482 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5483 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5484 @c different window or something like that.
5485 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5486 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5487 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5488 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5489 Different Languages}).
5490
5491 @table @code
5492 @item print @var{expr}
5493 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5494 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5495 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5496 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5497 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5498 Formats}.
5499
5500 @item print
5501 @itemx print /@var{f}
5502 @cindex reprint the last value
5503 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5504 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5505 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5506 @end table
5507
5508 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5509 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5510 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5511
5512 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5513 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5514 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5515 Table}.
5516
5517 @menu
5518 * Expressions:: Expressions
5519 * Variables:: Program variables
5520 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5521 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5522 * Memory:: Examining memory
5523 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5524 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5525 * Value History:: Value history
5526 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5527 * Registers:: Registers
5528 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5529 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5530 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5531 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5532 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5533 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5534 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5535 character set than GDB does
5536 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5537 @end menu
5538
5539 @node Expressions
5540 @section Expressions
5541
5542 @cindex expressions
5543 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5544 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5545 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5546 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5547 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5548 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5549 @ref{Compilation}.
5550
5551 @cindex arrays in expressions
5552 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5553 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5554 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5555 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5556
5557 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5558 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5559 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5560 languages.
5561
5562 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5563 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5564
5565 @cindex casts, in expressions
5566 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5567 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5568 at that address in memory.
5569 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5570
5571 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5572 to programming languages:
5573
5574 @table @code
5575 @item @@
5576 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5577 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5578
5579 @item ::
5580 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5581 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5582
5583 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5584 @cindex type casting memory
5585 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5586 @cindex casts, to view memory
5587 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5588 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5589 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5590 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5591 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5592 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5593 @end table
5594
5595 @node Variables
5596 @section Program Variables
5597
5598 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5599 in your program.
5600
5601 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5602 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5603
5604 @itemize @bullet
5605 @item
5606 global (or file-static)
5607 @end itemize
5608
5609 @noindent or
5610
5611 @itemize @bullet
5612 @item
5613 visible according to the scope rules of the
5614 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5615 @end itemize
5616
5617 @noindent This means that in the function
5618
5619 @smallexample
5620 foo (a)
5621 int a;
5622 @{
5623 bar (a);
5624 @{
5625 int b = test ();
5626 bar (b);
5627 @}
5628 @}
5629 @end smallexample
5630
5631 @noindent
5632 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5633 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5634 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5635 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5636
5637 @cindex variable name conflict
5638 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5639 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5640 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5641 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5642 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5643 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5644 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5645
5646 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5647 @ifnotinfo
5648 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5649 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5650 @end ifnotinfo
5651 @smallexample
5652 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5653 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656 @noindent
5657 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5658 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5659 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5660 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5661
5662 @smallexample
5663 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5664 @end smallexample
5665
5666 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5667 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5668 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5669 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5670 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5671 @c conflict?? --mew
5672
5673 @cindex wrong values
5674 @cindex variable values, wrong
5675 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5676 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5677 @quotation
5678 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5679 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5680 scope, and just before exit.
5681 @end quotation
5682 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5683 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5684 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5685 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5686 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5687 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5688 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5689 variable definitions may be gone.
5690
5691 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5692 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5693 when compiling.
5694
5695 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5696 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5697 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5698 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5699 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5700 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5701 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5702
5703 @smallexample
5704 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5705 @end smallexample
5706
5707 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5708 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5709 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5710 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5711 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5712 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5713 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5714 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5715 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5716 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5717 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5718
5719 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5720 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5721 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5722 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5723
5724 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5725 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5726 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5727 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5728 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5729 For program code
5730
5731 @smallexample
5732 char var0[] = "A";
5733 signed char var1[] = "A";
5734 @end smallexample
5735
5736 You get during debugging
5737 @smallexample
5738 (gdb) print var0
5739 $1 = "A"
5740 (gdb) print var1
5741 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5742 @end smallexample
5743
5744 @node Arrays
5745 @section Artificial Arrays
5746
5747 @cindex artificial array
5748 @cindex arrays
5749 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5750 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5751 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5752 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5753 program.
5754
5755 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5756 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5757 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5758 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5759 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5760 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5761 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5762 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5763 example. If a program says
5764
5765 @smallexample
5766 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5767 @end smallexample
5768
5769 @noindent
5770 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5771
5772 @smallexample
5773 p *array@@len
5774 @end smallexample
5775
5776 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5777 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5778 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5779 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5780 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5781
5782 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5783 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5784 The value need not be in memory:
5785 @smallexample
5786 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5787 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5788 @end smallexample
5789
5790 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5791 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5792 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5793 @smallexample
5794 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5795 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5796 @end smallexample
5797
5798 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5799 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5800 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5801 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5802 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5803 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5804 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5805 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5806 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5807 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5808
5809 @smallexample
5810 set $i = 0
5811 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5812 @key{RET}
5813 @key{RET}
5814 @dots{}
5815 @end smallexample
5816
5817 @node Output Formats
5818 @section Output Formats
5819
5820 @cindex formatted output
5821 @cindex output formats
5822 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5823 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5824 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5825 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5826 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5827
5828 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5829 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5830 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5831 letters supported are:
5832
5833 @table @code
5834 @item x
5835 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5836 hexadecimal.
5837
5838 @item d
5839 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5840
5841 @item u
5842 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5843
5844 @item o
5845 Print as integer in octal.
5846
5847 @item t
5848 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5849 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5850 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5851 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5852
5853 @item a
5854 @cindex unknown address, locating
5855 @cindex locate address
5856 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5857 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5858 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5859
5860 @smallexample
5861 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5862 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5863 @end smallexample
5864
5865 @noindent
5866 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5867 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5868
5869 @item c
5870 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5871 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5872 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5873 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5874
5875 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5876 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5877 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5878 data.
5879
5880 @item f
5881 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5882 using typical floating point syntax.
5883
5884 @item s
5885 @cindex printing strings
5886 @cindex printing byte arrays
5887 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5888 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5889 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5890 natural types.
5891
5892 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5893 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5894 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5895 array.
5896 @end table
5897
5898 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5899
5900 @smallexample
5901 p/x $pc
5902 @end smallexample
5903
5904 @noindent
5905 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5906 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5907
5908 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5909 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5910 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5911
5912 @node Memory
5913 @section Examining Memory
5914
5915 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5916 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5917
5918 @cindex examining memory
5919 @table @code
5920 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5921 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5922 @itemx x @var{addr}
5923 @itemx x
5924 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5925 @end table
5926
5927 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5928 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5929 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5930 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5931 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5932
5933 @table @r
5934 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5935 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5936 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5937 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5938 @c 4.1.2.
5939
5940 @item @var{f}, the display format
5941 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5942 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5943 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5944 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5945 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5946
5947 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5948 The unit size is any of
5949
5950 @table @code
5951 @item b
5952 Bytes.
5953 @item h
5954 Halfwords (two bytes).
5955 @item w
5956 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5957 @item g
5958 Giant words (eight bytes).
5959 @end table
5960
5961 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5962 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5963 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5964
5965 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5966 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5967 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5968 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5969 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5970 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5971 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5972 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5973 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5974 a value from memory).
5975 @end table
5976
5977 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5978 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5979 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5980 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5981 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5982
5983 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5984 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5985 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5986 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5987 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5988
5989 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5990 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5991 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5992 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5993 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5994 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5995 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5996 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5997 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5998
5999 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6000 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6001 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6002 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6003 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6004 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6005 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6006
6007 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6008 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6009 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6010 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6011 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6012 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6013 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6014 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6015 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6016
6017 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6018 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6019 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6020
6021 @cindex remote memory comparison
6022 @cindex verify remote memory image
6023 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6024 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6025 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6026 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6027 situations.
6028
6029 @table @code
6030 @kindex compare-sections
6031 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6032 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6033 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6034 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6035 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6036 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6037 remote request.
6038 @end table
6039
6040 @node Auto Display
6041 @section Automatic Display
6042 @cindex automatic display
6043 @cindex display of expressions
6044
6045 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6046 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6047 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6048 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6049 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6050 The automatic display looks like this:
6051
6052 @smallexample
6053 2: foo = 38
6054 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6055 @end smallexample
6056
6057 @noindent
6058 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6059 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6060 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6061 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6062 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6063 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6064
6065 @table @code
6066 @kindex display
6067 @item display @var{expr}
6068 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6069 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6070
6071 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6072
6073 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6074 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6075 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6076 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6077 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6078
6079 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6080 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6081 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6082 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6083 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6084 @end table
6085
6086 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6087 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6088 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6089
6090 @table @code
6091 @kindex delete display
6092 @kindex undisplay
6093 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6094 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6095 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6096
6097 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6098 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6099
6100 @kindex disable display
6101 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6102 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6103 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6104 enabled again later.
6105
6106 @kindex enable display
6107 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6108 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6109 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6110
6111 @item display
6112 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6113 done when your program stops.
6114
6115 @kindex info display
6116 @item info display
6117 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6118 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6119 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6120 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6121 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6122 @end table
6123
6124 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6125 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6126 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6127 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6128 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6129 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6130 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6131 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6132 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6133 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6134 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6135
6136 @node Print Settings
6137 @section Print Settings
6138
6139 @cindex format options
6140 @cindex print settings
6141 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6142 and symbols are printed.
6143
6144 @noindent
6145 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6146
6147 @table @code
6148 @kindex set print
6149 @item set print address
6150 @itemx set print address on
6151 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6152 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6153 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6154 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6155 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6156 @code{set print address on}:
6157
6158 @smallexample
6159 @group
6160 (@value{GDBP}) f
6161 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6162 at input.c:530
6163 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6164 @end group
6165 @end smallexample
6166
6167 @item set print address off
6168 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6169 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6170
6171 @smallexample
6172 @group
6173 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6174 (@value{GDBP}) f
6175 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6176 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6177 @end group
6178 @end smallexample
6179
6180 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6181 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6182 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6183 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6184
6185 @kindex show print
6186 @item show print address
6187 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6188 @end table
6189
6190 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6191 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6192 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6193 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6194 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6195 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6196 it prints a symbolic address:
6197
6198 @table @code
6199 @item set print symbol-filename on
6200 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6201 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6202 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6203 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6204
6205 @item set print symbol-filename off
6206 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6207 default.
6208
6209 @item show print symbol-filename
6210 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6211 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6212 @end table
6213
6214 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6215 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6216 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6217
6218 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6219 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6220
6221 @table @code
6222 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6223 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6224 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6225 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6226 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6227 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6228
6229 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6230 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6231 symbolic address.
6232 @end table
6233
6234 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6235 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6236 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6237 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6238 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6239 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6240 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6241 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6242
6243 @smallexample
6244 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6245 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6246 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6247 @end smallexample
6248
6249 @quotation
6250 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6251 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6252 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6253 @end quotation
6254
6255 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6256
6257 @table @code
6258 @item set print array
6259 @itemx set print array on
6260 @cindex pretty print arrays
6261 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6262 but uses more space. The default is off.
6263
6264 @item set print array off
6265 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6266
6267 @item show print array
6268 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6269 arrays.
6270
6271 @cindex print array indexes
6272 @item set print array-indexes
6273 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6274 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6275 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6276 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6277
6278 @item set print array-indexes off
6279 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6280
6281 @item show print array-indexes
6282 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6283 arrays.
6284
6285 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6286 @cindex number of array elements to print
6287 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6288 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6289 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6290 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6291 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6292 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6293 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6294
6295 @item show print elements
6296 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6297 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6298
6299 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6300 @cindex printing frame argument values
6301 @cindex print all frame argument values
6302 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6303 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6304 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6305 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6306 values are:
6307
6308 @table @code
6309 @item all
6310 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6311
6312 @item scalars
6313 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6314 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6315 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6316
6317 @smallexample
6318 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6319 at frame-args.c:23
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 @item none
6323 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6324 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6325
6326 @smallexample
6327 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6328 at frame-args.c:23
6329 @end smallexample
6330 @end table
6331
6332 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6333 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6334 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6335 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6336 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6337 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6338 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6339 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6340
6341 @item show print frame-arguments
6342 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6343
6344 @item set print repeats
6345 @cindex repeated array elements
6346 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6347 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6348 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6349 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6350 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6351 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6352 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6353
6354 @item show print repeats
6355 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6356 elements.
6357
6358 @item set print null-stop
6359 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6360 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6361 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6362 contain only short strings.
6363 The default is off.
6364
6365 @item show print null-stop
6366 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6367 @sc{null} character.
6368
6369 @item set print pretty on
6370 @cindex print structures in indented form
6371 @cindex indentation in structure display
6372 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6373 per line, like this:
6374
6375 @smallexample
6376 @group
6377 $1 = @{
6378 next = 0x0,
6379 flags = @{
6380 sweet = 1,
6381 sour = 1
6382 @},
6383 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6384 @}
6385 @end group
6386 @end smallexample
6387
6388 @item set print pretty off
6389 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6390
6391 @smallexample
6392 @group
6393 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6394 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6395 @end group
6396 @end smallexample
6397
6398 @noindent
6399 This is the default format.
6400
6401 @item show print pretty
6402 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6403
6404 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6405 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6406 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6407 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6408 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6409 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6410 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6411 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6412
6413 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6414 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6415 international character sets, and is the default.
6416
6417 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6418 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6419
6420 @item set print union on
6421 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6422 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6423 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6424
6425 @item set print union off
6426 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6427 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6428 instead.
6429
6430 @item show print union
6431 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6432 structures and other unions.
6433
6434 For example, given the declarations
6435
6436 @smallexample
6437 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6438 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6439 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6440 Bug_forms;
6441
6442 struct thing @{
6443 Species it;
6444 union @{
6445 Tree_forms tree;
6446 Bug_forms bug;
6447 @} form;
6448 @};
6449
6450 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6451 @end smallexample
6452
6453 @noindent
6454 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6455
6456 @smallexample
6457 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6458 @end smallexample
6459
6460 @noindent
6461 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6462
6463 @smallexample
6464 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6465 @end smallexample
6466
6467 @noindent
6468 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6469 and in Pascal.
6470 @end table
6471
6472 @need 1000
6473 @noindent
6474 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6475
6476 @table @code
6477 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6478 @item set print demangle
6479 @itemx set print demangle on
6480 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6481 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6482 linkage. The default is on.
6483
6484 @item show print demangle
6485 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6486
6487 @item set print asm-demangle
6488 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6489 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6490 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6491 The default is off.
6492
6493 @item show print asm-demangle
6494 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6495 or demangled form.
6496
6497 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6498 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6499 @kindex set demangle-style
6500 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6501 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6502 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6503
6504 @table @code
6505 @item auto
6506 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6507
6508 @item gnu
6509 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6510 This is the default.
6511
6512 @item hp
6513 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6514
6515 @item lucid
6516 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6517
6518 @item arm
6519 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6520 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6521 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6522 require further enhancement to permit that.
6523
6524 @end table
6525 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6526
6527 @item show demangle-style
6528 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6529
6530 @item set print object
6531 @itemx set print object on
6532 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6533 @cindex display derived types
6534 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6535 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6536 the virtual function table.
6537
6538 @item set print object off
6539 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6540 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6541
6542 @item show print object
6543 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6544
6545 @item set print static-members
6546 @itemx set print static-members on
6547 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6548 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6549
6550 @item set print static-members off
6551 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6552
6553 @item show print static-members
6554 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6555
6556 @item set print pascal_static-members
6557 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6558 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6559 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6560 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6561
6562 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6563 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6564
6565 @item show print pascal_static-members
6566 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6567
6568 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6569 @item set print vtbl
6570 @itemx set print vtbl on
6571 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6572 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6573 @cindex VTBL display
6574 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6575 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6576 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6577
6578 @item set print vtbl off
6579 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6580
6581 @item show print vtbl
6582 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6583 @end table
6584
6585 @node Value History
6586 @section Value History
6587
6588 @cindex value history
6589 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6590 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6591 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6592 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6593 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6594 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6595 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6596 symbol table.
6597
6598 @cindex @code{$}
6599 @cindex @code{$$}
6600 @cindex history number
6601 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6602 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6603 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6604 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6605 history number.
6606
6607 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6608 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6609 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6610 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6611 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6612 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6613 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6614
6615 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6616 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6617
6618 @smallexample
6619 p *$
6620 @end smallexample
6621
6622 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6623 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6624
6625 @smallexample
6626 p *$.next
6627 @end smallexample
6628
6629 @noindent
6630 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6631 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6632
6633 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6634 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6635
6636 @smallexample
6637 print x
6638 set x=5
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6643 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6644
6645 @table @code
6646 @kindex show values
6647 @item show values
6648 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6649 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6650 values} does not change the history.
6651
6652 @item show values @var{n}
6653 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6654
6655 @item show values +
6656 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6657 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6658 @end table
6659
6660 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6661 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6662
6663 @node Convenience Vars
6664 @section Convenience Variables
6665
6666 @cindex convenience variables
6667 @cindex user-defined variables
6668 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6669 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6670 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6671 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6672 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6673
6674 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6675 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6676 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6677 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6678 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6679
6680 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6681 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6682 For example:
6683
6684 @smallexample
6685 set $foo = *object_ptr
6686 @end smallexample
6687
6688 @noindent
6689 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6690 @code{object_ptr}.
6691
6692 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6693 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6694 value with another assignment at any time.
6695
6696 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6697 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6698 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6699 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6700
6701 @table @code
6702 @kindex show convenience
6703 @cindex show all user variables
6704 @item show convenience
6705 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6706 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6707
6708 @kindex init-if-undefined
6709 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6710 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6711 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6712 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6713 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6714 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6715 override default values used in a command script.
6716
6717 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6718 any side-effects do not occur.
6719 @end table
6720
6721 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6722 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6723 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6724
6725 @smallexample
6726 set $i = 0
6727 print bar[$i++]->contents
6728 @end smallexample
6729
6730 @noindent
6731 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6732
6733 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6734 values likely to be useful.
6735
6736 @table @code
6737 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6738 @item $_
6739 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6740 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6741 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6742 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6743 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6744 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6745 to the type of @code{$__}.
6746
6747 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6748 @item $__
6749 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6750 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6751 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6752
6753 @item $_exitcode
6754 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6755 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6756 the program being debugged terminates.
6757 @end table
6758
6759 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6760 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6761 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6762
6763 @node Registers
6764 @section Registers
6765
6766 @cindex registers
6767 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6768 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6769 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6770 your machine.
6771
6772 @table @code
6773 @kindex info registers
6774 @item info registers
6775 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6776 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6777
6778 @kindex info all-registers
6779 @cindex floating point registers
6780 @item info all-registers
6781 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6782 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6783
6784 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6785 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6786 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6787 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6788 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6789 @end table
6790
6791 @cindex stack pointer register
6792 @cindex program counter register
6793 @cindex process status register
6794 @cindex frame pointer register
6795 @cindex standard registers
6796 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6797 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6798 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6799 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6800 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6801 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6802 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6803 you could print the program counter in hex with
6804
6805 @smallexample
6806 p/x $pc
6807 @end smallexample
6808
6809 @noindent
6810 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6811
6812 @smallexample
6813 x/i $pc
6814 @end smallexample
6815
6816 @noindent
6817 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6818 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6819 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6820 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6821 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6822 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6823 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6824
6825 @smallexample
6826 set $sp += 4
6827 @end smallexample
6828
6829 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6830 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6831 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6832 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6833 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6834 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6835 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6836
6837 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6838 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6839 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6840 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6841 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6842 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6843 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6844
6845 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6846 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6847 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6848 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6849 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6850 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6851 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6852 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6853 prints the data in both formats.
6854
6855 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6856 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6857 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6858 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6859 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6860 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6861 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6862
6863 @smallexample
6864 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6865 $1 = @{
6866 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6867 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6868 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6869 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6870 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6871 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6872 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6873 @}
6874 @end smallexample
6875
6876 @noindent
6877 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6878 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6879 value to a @code{struct} member:
6880
6881 @smallexample
6882 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6883 @end smallexample
6884
6885 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6886 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6887 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6888 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6889 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6890 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6891
6892 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6893 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6894 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6895 frame makes no difference.
6896
6897 @node Floating Point Hardware
6898 @section Floating Point Hardware
6899 @cindex floating point
6900
6901 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6902 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6903
6904 @table @code
6905 @kindex info float
6906 @item info float
6907 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6908 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6909 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6910 the ARM and x86 machines.
6911 @end table
6912
6913 @node Vector Unit
6914 @section Vector Unit
6915 @cindex vector unit
6916
6917 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6918 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6919
6920 @table @code
6921 @kindex info vector
6922 @item info vector
6923 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6924 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6925 @end table
6926
6927 @node OS Information
6928 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6929 @cindex OS information
6930
6931 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6932 you debug your program.
6933
6934 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6935 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6936 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6937 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6938 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6939 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6940 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6941 structure.
6942
6943 @table @code
6944 @item info udot
6945 @kindex info udot
6946 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6947 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6948 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6949 the @code{examine} command.
6950 @end table
6951
6952 @cindex auxiliary vector
6953 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6954 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6955 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6956 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6957 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6958 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6959 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6960 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6961 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6962 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6963 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6964 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6965
6966 @table @code
6967 @kindex info auxv
6968 @item info auxv
6969 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6970 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6971 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6972 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6973 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6974 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6975 an unrecognized tag.
6976 @end table
6977
6978
6979 @node Memory Region Attributes
6980 @section Memory Region Attributes
6981 @cindex memory region attributes
6982
6983 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6984 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6985 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6986 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6987 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6988 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6989 user can override the fetched regions.
6990
6991 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6992 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6993 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6994 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6995 all memory.
6996
6997 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6998 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6999
7000 @table @code
7001 @kindex mem
7002 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7003 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7004 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7005 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7006 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7007 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7008
7009 @item mem auto
7010 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7011 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7012
7013 @kindex delete mem
7014 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7015 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7016 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7017
7018 @kindex disable mem
7019 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7020 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7021 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7022 It may be enabled again later.
7023
7024 @kindex enable mem
7025 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7026 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7027
7028 @kindex info mem
7029 @item info mem
7030 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7031 for each region:
7032
7033 @table @emph
7034 @item Memory Region Number
7035 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7036 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7037 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7038
7039 @item Lo Address
7040 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7041
7042 @item Hi Address
7043 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7044
7045 @item Attributes
7046 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7047 @end table
7048 @end table
7049
7050
7051 @subsection Attributes
7052
7053 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7054 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7055 write accesses to a memory region.
7056
7057 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7058 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7059 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7060
7061 @table @code
7062 @item ro
7063 Memory is read only.
7064 @item wo
7065 Memory is write only.
7066 @item rw
7067 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7068 @end table
7069
7070 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7071 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7072 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7073 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7074 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7075
7076 @table @code
7077 @item 8
7078 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7079 @item 16
7080 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7081 @item 32
7082 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7083 @item 64
7084 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7085 @end table
7086
7087 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7088 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7089 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7090 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7091 @c
7092 @c @table @code
7093 @c @item hwbreak
7094 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7095 @c @item swbreak (default)
7096 @c @end table
7097
7098 @subsubsection Data Cache
7099 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7100 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7101 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7102 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7103 registers.
7104
7105 @table @code
7106 @item cache
7107 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7108 @item nocache
7109 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7110 @end table
7111
7112 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7113 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7114 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7115 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7116 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7117
7118 @table @code
7119 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7120 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7121 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7122 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7123 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7124 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7125 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7126 The default value is @code{on}.
7127 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7128 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7129 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7130 @end table
7131
7132
7133 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7134 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7135 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7136 @c
7137 @c @table @code
7138 @c @item verify
7139 @c @item noverify (default)
7140 @c @end table
7141
7142 @node Dump/Restore Files
7143 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7144 @cindex dump/restore files
7145 @cindex append data to a file
7146 @cindex dump data to a file
7147 @cindex restore data from a file
7148
7149 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7150 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7151 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7152 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7153 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7154 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7155 files.
7156
7157 @table @code
7158
7159 @kindex dump
7160 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7161 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7162 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7163 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7164
7165 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7166 @table @code
7167 @item binary
7168 Raw binary form.
7169 @item ihex
7170 Intel hex format.
7171 @item srec
7172 Motorola S-record format.
7173 @item tekhex
7174 Tektronix Hex format.
7175 @end table
7176
7177 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7178 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7179 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7180 form.
7181
7182 @kindex append
7183 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7184 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7185 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7186 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7187 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7188
7189 @kindex restore
7190 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7191 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7192 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7193 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7194 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7195
7196 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7197 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7198 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7199 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7200 from that location.
7201
7202 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7203 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7204 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7205 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7206
7207 @end table
7208
7209 @node Core File Generation
7210 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7211 @cindex dump core from inferior
7212
7213 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7214 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7215 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7216 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7217 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7218 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7219 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7220
7221 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7222 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7223 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7224
7225 @table @code
7226 @kindex gcore
7227 @kindex generate-core-file
7228 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7229 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7230 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7231 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7232 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7233 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7234
7235 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7236 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7237 @end table
7238
7239 @node Character Sets
7240 @section Character Sets
7241 @cindex character sets
7242 @cindex charset
7243 @cindex translating between character sets
7244 @cindex host character set
7245 @cindex target character set
7246
7247 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7248 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7249 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7250 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7251 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7252 @dfn{target character set}.
7253
7254 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7255 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7256 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7257 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7258 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7259 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7260 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7261 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7262 character and string literals in expressions.
7263
7264 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7265 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7266 target-charset} command, described below.
7267
7268 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7269 support:
7270
7271 @table @code
7272 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7273 @kindex set target-charset
7274 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7275 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7276 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7277 list the target character sets it supports.
7278 @end table
7279
7280 @table @code
7281 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7282 @kindex set host-charset
7283 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7284
7285 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7286 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7287 @code{set host-charset} command.
7288
7289 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7290 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7291 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7292 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7293 list the host character sets it supports.
7294
7295 @item set charset @var{charset}
7296 @kindex set charset
7297 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7298 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7299 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7300 for both host and target.
7301
7302
7303 @item show charset
7304 @kindex show charset
7305 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7306
7307 @itemx show host-charset
7308 @kindex show host-charset
7309 Show the name of the current host charset.
7310
7311 @itemx show target-charset
7312 @kindex show target-charset
7313 Show the name of the current target charset.
7314
7315 @end table
7316
7317 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7318 sets:
7319
7320 @table @code
7321
7322 @item ASCII
7323 @cindex ASCII character set
7324 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7325 character set.
7326
7327 @item ISO-8859-1
7328 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7329 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7330 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7331 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7332 this as its host character set.
7333
7334 @item EBCDIC-US
7335 @itemx IBM1047
7336 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7337 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7338 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7339 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7340 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7341
7342 @end table
7343
7344 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7345 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7346 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7347
7348 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7349 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7350 @file{charset-test.c}:
7351
7352 @smallexample
7353 #include <stdio.h>
7354
7355 char ascii_hello[]
7356 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7357 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7358 char ibm1047_hello[]
7359 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7360 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7361
7362 main ()
7363 @{
7364 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7365 @}
7366 @end smallexample
7367
7368 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7369 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7370 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7371
7372 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7373
7374 @smallexample
7375 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7376 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7377 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7378 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7379 @dots{}
7380 (@value{GDBP})
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7384 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7385 strings:
7386
7387 @smallexample
7388 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7389 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7390 (@value{GDBP})
7391 @end smallexample
7392
7393 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7394 initial character set:
7395 @smallexample
7396 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7397 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7398 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7399 (@value{GDBP})
7400 @end smallexample
7401
7402 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7403 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7404 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7405 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7406 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7407
7408 @smallexample
7409 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7410 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7411 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7412 $2 = 72 'H'
7413 (@value{GDBP})
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7417 literals you use in expressions:
7418
7419 @smallexample
7420 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7421 $3 = 43 '+'
7422 (@value{GDBP})
7423 @end smallexample
7424
7425 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7426 character.
7427
7428 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7429 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7430 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7431
7432 @smallexample
7433 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7434 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7435 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7436 $5 = 200 '\310'
7437 (@value{GDBP})
7438 @end smallexample
7439
7440 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7441 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7442
7443 @smallexample
7444 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7445 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7446 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7450 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7451 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7452 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7453 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7454
7455 @smallexample
7456 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7457 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7458 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7459 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7460 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7461 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7462 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7463 $7 = 72 '\110'
7464 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7465 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7466 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7467 $9 = 200 'H'
7468 (@value{GDBP})
7469 @end smallexample
7470
7471 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7472 string literals you use in expressions:
7473
7474 @smallexample
7475 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7476 $10 = 78 '+'
7477 (@value{GDBP})
7478 @end smallexample
7479
7480 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7481 character.
7482
7483 @node Caching Remote Data
7484 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7485 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7486
7487 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7488 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7489 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7490 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7491 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7492 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7493 volatile registers are in use.
7494
7495 @table @code
7496 @kindex set remotecache
7497 @item set remotecache on
7498 @itemx set remotecache off
7499 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7500 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7501
7502 @kindex show remotecache
7503 @item show remotecache
7504 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7505
7506 @kindex info dcache
7507 @item info dcache
7508 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7509 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7510 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7511 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7512 the data cache operation.
7513 @end table
7514
7515
7516 @node Macros
7517 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7518
7519 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7520 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7521 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7522 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7523 where it was defined.
7524
7525 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7526 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7527 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7528 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7529
7530 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7531 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7532 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7533 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7534 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7535 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7536 see @ref{List}.
7537
7538 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7539 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7540 variable-arity macros.
7541
7542 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7543 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7544 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7545
7546 @table @code
7547
7548 @kindex macro expand
7549 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7550 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7551 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7552 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7553 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7554 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7555 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7556 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7557 it can be any string of tokens.
7558
7559 @kindex macro exp1
7560 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7561 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7562 @cindex expand macro once
7563 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7564 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7565 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7566 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7567 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7568 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7569 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7570 can be any string of tokens.
7571
7572 @kindex info macro
7573 @cindex macro definition, showing
7574 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7575 @item info macro @var{macro}
7576 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7577 source location where that definition was established.
7578
7579 @kindex macro define
7580 @cindex user-defined macros
7581 @cindex defining macros interactively
7582 @cindex macros, user-defined
7583 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7584 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7585 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7586 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7587 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7588 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7589 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7590 given in @var{arglist}.
7591
7592 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7593 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7594 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7595 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7596 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7597
7598 @kindex macro undef
7599 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7600 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7601 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7602 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7603 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7604 debugged.
7605
7606 @kindex macro list
7607 @item macro list
7608 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7609 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7610 @end table
7611
7612 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7613 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7614 show our source files:
7615
7616 @smallexample
7617 $ cat sample.c
7618 #include <stdio.h>
7619 #include "sample.h"
7620
7621 #define M 42
7622 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7623
7624 main ()
7625 @{
7626 #define N 28
7627 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7628 #undef N
7629 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7630 #define N 1729
7631 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7632 @}
7633 $ cat sample.h
7634 #define Q <
7635 $
7636 @end smallexample
7637
7638 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7639 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7640 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7641 information.
7642
7643 @smallexample
7644 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7645 $
7646 @end smallexample
7647
7648 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7649
7650 @smallexample
7651 $ gdb -nw sample
7652 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7653 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7654 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7655 (@value{GDBP})
7656 @end smallexample
7657
7658 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7659 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7660 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7661
7662 @smallexample
7663 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7664 3
7665 4 #define M 42
7666 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7667 6
7668 7 main ()
7669 8 @{
7670 9 #define N 28
7671 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7672 11 #undef N
7673 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7674 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7675 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7676 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7677 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7678 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7679 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7680 #define Q <
7681 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7682 expands to: (42 + 1)
7683 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7684 expands to: once (M + 1)
7685 (@value{GDBP})
7686 @end smallexample
7687
7688 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7689 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7690 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7691 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7692
7693 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7694 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7695
7696 @smallexample
7697 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7698 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7699 (@value{GDBP}) run
7700 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7701
7702 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7703 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7704 (@value{GDBP})
7705 @end smallexample
7706
7707 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7708
7709 @smallexample
7710 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7711 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7712 #define N 28
7713 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7714 expands to: 28 < 42
7715 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7716 $1 = 1
7717 (@value{GDBP})
7718 @end smallexample
7719
7720 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7721 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7722 thereof) in force at each point:
7723
7724 @smallexample
7725 (@value{GDBP}) next
7726 Hello, world!
7727 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7728 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7729 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7730 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7731 (@value{GDBP}) next
7732 We're so creative.
7733 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7734 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7735 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7736 #define N 1729
7737 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7738 expands to: 1729 < 42
7739 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7740 $2 = 0
7741 (@value{GDBP})
7742 @end smallexample
7743
7744
7745 @node Tracepoints
7746 @chapter Tracepoints
7747 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7748 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7749
7750 @cindex tracepoints
7751 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7752 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7753 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7754 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7755 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7756 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7757 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7758
7759 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7760 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7761 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7762 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7763 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7764 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7765 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7766 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7767 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7768 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7769 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7770
7771 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7772 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7773 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7774 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7775 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7776 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7777 Packets}.
7778
7779 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7780
7781 @menu
7782 * Set Tracepoints::
7783 * Analyze Collected Data::
7784 * Tracepoint Variables::
7785 @end menu
7786
7787 @node Set Tracepoints
7788 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7789
7790 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7791 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7792 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7793 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7794 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7795 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7796 work on.
7797
7798 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7799 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7800 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7801 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7802 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7803 tracepoint was hit.
7804
7805 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7806 conditions and actions.
7807
7808 @menu
7809 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7810 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7811 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7812 * Tracepoint Actions::
7813 * Listing Tracepoints::
7814 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7815 @end menu
7816
7817 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7818 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7819
7820 @table @code
7821 @cindex set tracepoint
7822 @kindex trace
7823 @item trace
7824 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7825 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7826 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7827 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7828 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7829 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7830 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7831 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7832 running.
7833
7834 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7835
7836 @smallexample
7837 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7838
7839 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7840
7841 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7842
7843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7844
7845 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7846 @end smallexample
7847
7848 @noindent
7849 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7850
7851 @vindex $tpnum
7852 @cindex last tracepoint number
7853 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7854 @cindex tracepoint number
7855 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7856 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7857
7858 @kindex delete tracepoint
7859 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7860 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7861 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7862 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7863
7864 Examples:
7865
7866 @smallexample
7867 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7868
7869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7870 @end smallexample
7871
7872 @noindent
7873 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7874 @end table
7875
7876 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7877 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7878
7879 @table @code
7880 @kindex disable tracepoint
7881 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7882 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7883 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7884 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7885 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7886
7887 @kindex enable tracepoint
7888 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7889 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7890 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7891 run.
7892 @end table
7893
7894 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7895 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7896
7897 @table @code
7898 @kindex passcount
7899 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7900 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7901 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7902 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7903 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7904 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7905 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7906 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7907 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7908 user.
7909
7910 Examples:
7911
7912 @smallexample
7913 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7914 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7915
7916 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7917 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7918 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7919 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7920 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7921 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7923 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7924 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7925 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7926 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7927 @end smallexample
7928 @end table
7929
7930 @node Tracepoint Actions
7931 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7932
7933 @table @code
7934 @kindex actions
7935 @cindex tracepoint actions
7936 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7937 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7938 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7939 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7940 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7941 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7942 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7943 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7944 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7945 @code{while-stepping}.
7946
7947 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7948 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7949 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7950
7951 @smallexample
7952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7953
7954 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7955
7956 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7957 @end smallexample
7958
7959 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7960 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7961 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7962 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7963 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7964 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7965 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7966 @code{end} command.
7967
7968 @smallexample
7969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7971 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7972 > collect bar,baz
7973 > collect $regs
7974 > while-stepping 12
7975 > collect $fp, $sp
7976 > end
7977 end
7978 @end smallexample
7979
7980 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7981 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7982 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7983 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7984 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7985 special arguments are supported:
7986
7987 @table @code
7988 @item $regs
7989 collect all registers
7990
7991 @item $args
7992 collect all function arguments
7993
7994 @item $locals
7995 collect all local variables.
7996 @end table
7997
7998 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7999 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8000 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8001
8002 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8003 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8004
8005 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8006 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8007 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8008 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8009 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8010 its own @code{end} command):
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 > while-stepping 12
8014 > collect $regs, myglobal
8015 > end
8016 >
8017 @end smallexample
8018
8019 @noindent
8020 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8021 @code{stepping}.
8022 @end table
8023
8024 @node Listing Tracepoints
8025 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8026
8027 @table @code
8028 @kindex info tracepoints
8029 @kindex info tp
8030 @cindex information about tracepoints
8031 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8032 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8033 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8034 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8035 shown:
8036
8037 @itemize @bullet
8038 @item
8039 its number
8040 @item
8041 whether it is enabled or disabled
8042 @item
8043 its address
8044 @item
8045 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8046 @item
8047 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8048 @item
8049 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8050 @item
8051 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8052 @end itemize
8053
8054 @smallexample
8055 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8056 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8057 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8058 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8059 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8060 (@value{GDBP})
8061 @end smallexample
8062
8063 @noindent
8064 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8065 @end table
8066
8067 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8068 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8069
8070 @table @code
8071 @kindex tstart
8072 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8073 @cindex collected data discarded
8074 @item tstart
8075 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8076 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8077 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8078 experiment.
8079
8080 @kindex tstop
8081 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8082 @item tstop
8083 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8084 stops collecting data.
8085
8086 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8087 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8088 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8089
8090 @kindex tstatus
8091 @cindex status of trace data collection
8092 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8093 @item tstatus
8094 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8095 collection.
8096 @end table
8097
8098 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8099
8100 @smallexample
8101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8102 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8103 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8104 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8105 > while-stepping 11
8106 > collect $regs
8107 > end
8108 > end
8109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8110 [time passes @dots{}]
8111 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8112 @end smallexample
8113
8114
8115 @node Analyze Collected Data
8116 @section Using the Collected Data
8117
8118 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8119 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8120 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8121 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8122 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8123 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8124 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8125 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8126 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8127 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8128 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8129 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8130 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8131 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8132 the buffer will fail.
8133
8134 @menu
8135 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8136 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8137 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8138 @end menu
8139
8140 @node tfind
8141 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8142
8143 @kindex tfind
8144 @cindex select trace snapshot
8145 @cindex find trace snapshot
8146 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8147 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8148 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8149 snapshot is selected.
8150
8151 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8152
8153 @table @code
8154 @item tfind start
8155 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8156 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8157
8158 @item tfind none
8159 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8160
8161 @item tfind end
8162 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8163
8164 @item tfind
8165 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8166
8167 @item tfind -
8168 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8169 retracing earlier steps.
8170
8171 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8172 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8173 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8174 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8175 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8176
8177 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8178 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8179 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8180 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8181 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8182
8183 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8184 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8185 addresses.
8186
8187 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8188 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8189 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8190
8191 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8192 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8193 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8194 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8195 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8196 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8197 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8198 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8199 @end table
8200
8201 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8202 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8203 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8204 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8205 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8206 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8207 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8208 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8209 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8210 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8211 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8212 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8213 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8214 tracepoint as the current one.
8215
8216 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8217 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8218 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8219 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8220 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8221
8222 @smallexample
8223 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8225 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8226 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8227 > tfind
8228 > end
8229
8230 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8231 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8232 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8233 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8234 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8235 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8236 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8237 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8238 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8239 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8240 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8241 @end smallexample
8242
8243 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8244 the buffer:
8245
8246 @smallexample
8247 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8248 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8249 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8250 > tfind line
8251 > end
8252
8253 Frame 0, X = 1
8254 Frame 7, X = 2
8255 Frame 13, X = 255
8256 @end smallexample
8257
8258 @node tdump
8259 @subsection @code{tdump}
8260 @kindex tdump
8261 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8262 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8263
8264 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8265 the current trace snapshot.
8266
8267 @smallexample
8268 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8269 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8270 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8271 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8272 > end
8273
8274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8275
8276 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8277 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8278 at gdb_test.c:444
8279 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8280
8281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8282 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8283 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8284 d1 0x18 24
8285 d2 0x80 128
8286 d3 0x33 51
8287 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8288 d5 0x22 34
8289 d6 0xe0 224
8290 d7 0x380035 3670069
8291 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8292 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8293 a2 0x100 256
8294 a3 0x322000 3284992
8295 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8296 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8297 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8298 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8299 ps 0x0 0
8300 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8301 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8302 fpstatus 0x0 0
8303 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8304 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8305 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8306 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8307 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8308 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8309 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8310 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8311 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8312
8313 (@value{GDBP})
8314 @end smallexample
8315
8316 @node save-tracepoints
8317 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8318 @kindex save-tracepoints
8319 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8320
8321 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8322 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8323 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8324 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8325 Files}).
8326
8327 @node Tracepoint Variables
8328 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8329 @cindex tracepoint variables
8330 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8331
8332 @table @code
8333 @vindex $trace_frame
8334 @item (int) $trace_frame
8335 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8336 snapshot is selected.
8337
8338 @vindex $tracepoint
8339 @item (int) $tracepoint
8340 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8341
8342 @vindex $trace_line
8343 @item (int) $trace_line
8344 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8345
8346 @vindex $trace_file
8347 @item (char []) $trace_file
8348 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8349
8350 @vindex $trace_func
8351 @item (char []) $trace_func
8352 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8353 @end table
8354
8355 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8356 use @code{output} instead.
8357
8358 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8359 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8360 data.
8361
8362 @smallexample
8363 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8364
8365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8366 > output $trace_file
8367 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8368 > tfind
8369 > end
8370 @end smallexample
8371
8372 @node Overlays
8373 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8374 @cindex overlays
8375
8376 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8377 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8378 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8379 use overlays.
8380
8381 @menu
8382 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8383 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8384 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8385 mapped by asking the inferior.
8386 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8387 @end menu
8388
8389 @node How Overlays Work
8390 @section How Overlays Work
8391 @cindex mapped overlays
8392 @cindex unmapped overlays
8393 @cindex load address, overlay's
8394 @cindex mapped address
8395 @cindex overlay area
8396
8397 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8398 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8399 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8400 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8401 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8402
8403 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8404 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8405 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8406 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8407 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8408 largest overlay as well.
8409
8410 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8411 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8412 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8413 there.
8414
8415 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8416 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8417 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8418
8419 @smallexample
8420 @group
8421 Data Instruction Larger
8422 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8423 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8424 | | | | | |
8425 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8426 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8427 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8428 | and heap | | | | | |
8429 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8430 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8431 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8432 | | | | | |
8433 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8434 address | | | | | |
8435 | overlay | <-' | | |
8436 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8437 | | <---. | | load address
8438 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8439 | | | |
8440 +-----------+ | |
8441 +-----------+
8442 | |
8443 +-----------+
8444
8445 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8446 @end group
8447 @end smallexample
8448
8449 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8450 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8451 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8452 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8453 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8454 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8455 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8456 program and the overlay area.
8457
8458 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8459 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8460 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8461 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8462 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8463 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8464 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8465
8466 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8467 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8468 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8469
8470 @itemize @bullet
8471
8472 @item
8473 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8474 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8475 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8476 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8477
8478 @item
8479 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8480 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8481 your program's performance.
8482
8483 @item
8484 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8485 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8486 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8487 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8488 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8489 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8490 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8491
8492 @item
8493 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8494 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8495 instruction and data spaces.
8496
8497 @end itemize
8498
8499 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8500 improved in many ways:
8501
8502 @itemize @bullet
8503
8504 @item
8505 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8506 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8507 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8508 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8509 area in the usual way.
8510
8511 @item
8512 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8513 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8514
8515 @item
8516 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8517 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8518 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8519 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8520 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8521 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8522 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8523
8524 @end itemize
8525
8526
8527 @node Overlay Commands
8528 @section Overlay Commands
8529
8530 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8531 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8532 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8533 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8534 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8535 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8536
8537 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8538 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8539
8540 @table @code
8541 @item overlay off
8542 @kindex overlay
8543 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8544 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8545 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8546 overlay support is disabled.
8547
8548 @item overlay manual
8549 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8550 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8551 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8552 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8553 commands described below.
8554
8555 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8556 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8557 @cindex map an overlay
8558 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8559 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8560 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8561 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8562 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8563 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8564
8565 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8566 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8567 @cindex unmap an overlay
8568 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8569 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8570 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8571 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8572
8573 @item overlay auto
8574 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8575 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8576 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8577 Overlay Debugging}.
8578
8579 @item overlay load-target
8580 @itemx overlay load
8581 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8582 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8583 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8584 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8585 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8586 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8587
8588 @item overlay list-overlays
8589 @itemx overlay list
8590 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8591 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8592 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8593
8594 @end table
8595
8596 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8597 of the function the address falls in:
8598
8599 @smallexample
8600 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8601 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8602 @end smallexample
8603 @noindent
8604 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8605 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8606 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8607 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8608
8609 @smallexample
8610 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8611 No sections are mapped.
8612 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8613 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8614 @end smallexample
8615 @noindent
8616 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8617 name normally:
8618
8619 @smallexample
8620 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8621 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8622 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8623 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8624 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8625 @end smallexample
8626
8627 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8628 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8629 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8630 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8631 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8632
8633 @itemize @bullet
8634 @item
8635 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8636 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8637 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8638 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8639 @item
8640 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8641 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8642 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8643 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8644 breakpoints properly.
8645 @end itemize
8646
8647
8648 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8649 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8650 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8651
8652 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8653 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8654 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8655 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8656 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8657 current state of the overlays.
8658
8659 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8660 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8661
8662 @table @asis
8663
8664 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8665 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8666
8667 @smallexample
8668 struct
8669 @{
8670 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8671 unsigned long vma;
8672
8673 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8674 unsigned long size;
8675
8676 /* The overlay's load address. */
8677 unsigned long lma;
8678
8679 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8680 zero otherwise. */
8681 unsigned long mapped;
8682 @}
8683 @end smallexample
8684
8685 @item @code{_novlys}:
8686 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8687 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8688
8689 @end table
8690
8691 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8692 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8693 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8694 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8695 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8696 currently mapped.
8697
8698 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8699 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8700 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8701 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8702 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8703 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8704 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8705 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8706 are not being executed.
8707
8708 @node Overlay Sample Program
8709 @section Overlay Sample Program
8710 @cindex overlay example program
8711
8712 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8713 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8714 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8715 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8716 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8717 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8718 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8719
8720 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8721 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8722 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8723 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8724
8725 @table @file
8726 @item overlays.c
8727 The main program file.
8728 @item ovlymgr.c
8729 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8730 @item foo.c
8731 @itemx bar.c
8732 @itemx baz.c
8733 @itemx grbx.c
8734 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8735 @item d10v.ld
8736 @itemx m32r.ld
8737 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8738 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8739 @end table
8740
8741 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8742 cross-compiler like this:
8743
8744 @smallexample
8745 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8746 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8747 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8748 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8749 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8750 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8751 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8752 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8753 @end smallexample
8754
8755 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8756 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8757 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8758
8759
8760 @node Languages
8761 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8762 @cindex languages
8763
8764 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8765 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8766 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8767 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8768 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8769 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8770
8771 @cindex working language
8772 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8773 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8774 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8775 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8776 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8777 language}.
8778
8779 @menu
8780 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8781 * Show:: Displaying the language
8782 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8783 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8784 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8785 @end menu
8786
8787 @node Setting
8788 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8789
8790 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8791 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8792 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8793 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8794 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8795 are printed, etc.
8796
8797 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8798 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8799 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8800 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8801 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8802 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8803 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8804 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8805 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8806 Displaying the Language}.
8807
8808 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8809 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8810 another language. In that case, make the
8811 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8812 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8813 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8814
8815 @menu
8816 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8817 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8818 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8819 @end menu
8820
8821 @node Filenames
8822 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8823
8824 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8825 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8826
8827 @table @file
8828 @item .ada
8829 @itemx .ads
8830 @itemx .adb
8831 @itemx .a
8832 Ada source file.
8833
8834 @item .c
8835 C source file
8836
8837 @item .C
8838 @itemx .cc
8839 @itemx .cp
8840 @itemx .cpp
8841 @itemx .cxx
8842 @itemx .c++
8843 C@t{++} source file
8844
8845 @item .m
8846 Objective-C source file
8847
8848 @item .f
8849 @itemx .F
8850 Fortran source file
8851
8852 @item .mod
8853 Modula-2 source file
8854
8855 @item .s
8856 @itemx .S
8857 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8858 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8859 @end table
8860
8861 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8862 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8863
8864 @node Manually
8865 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8866
8867 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8868 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8869 your program.
8870
8871 @kindex set language
8872 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8873 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8874 a language, such as
8875 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8876 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8877
8878 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8879 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8880 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8881 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8882 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8883 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8884 command such as:
8885
8886 @smallexample
8887 print a = b + c
8888 @end smallexample
8889
8890 @noindent
8891 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8892 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8893 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8894 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8895
8896 @node Automatically
8897 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8898
8899 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8900 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8901 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8902 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8903 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8904 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8905 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8906 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8907 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8908
8909 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8910 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8911 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8912 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8913 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8914
8915 @node Show
8916 @section Displaying the Language
8917
8918 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8919 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8920
8921 @table @code
8922 @item show language
8923 @kindex show language
8924 Display the current working language. This is the
8925 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8926 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8927
8928 @item info frame
8929 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8930 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8931 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8932 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8933 information listed here.
8934
8935 @item info source
8936 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8937 Display the source language of this source file.
8938 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8939 information listed here.
8940 @end table
8941
8942 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8943 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8944 with a language explicitly:
8945
8946 @table @code
8947 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8948 @kindex set extension-language
8949 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8950 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8951
8952 @item info extensions
8953 @kindex info extensions
8954 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8955 @end table
8956
8957 @node Checks
8958 @section Type and Range Checking
8959
8960 @quotation
8961 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8962 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8963 section documents the intended facilities.
8964 @end quotation
8965 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8966
8967 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8968 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8969 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8970 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8971 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8972 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8973 errors when your program is running.
8974
8975 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8976 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8977 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8978 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8979 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8980 automatically based on your program's source language.
8981 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8982 settings of supported languages.
8983
8984 @menu
8985 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8986 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8987 @end menu
8988
8989 @cindex type checking
8990 @cindex checks, type
8991 @node Type Checking
8992 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8993
8994 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8995 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8996 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8997 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8998
8999 @smallexample
9000 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9001 @exdent but
9002 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9003 @end smallexample
9004
9005 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9006 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9007
9008 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9009 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9010 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9011 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9012 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9013 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9014 also issues a warning.
9015
9016 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9017 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9018 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9019 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9020 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9021 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9022
9023 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9024 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9025 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9026 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9027 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9028 details on specific languages.
9029
9030 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9031
9032 @kindex set check type
9033 @kindex show check type
9034 @table @code
9035 @item set check type auto
9036 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9037 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9038 each language.
9039
9040 @item set check type on
9041 @itemx set check type off
9042 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9043 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9044 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9045 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9046 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9047
9048 @item set check type warn
9049 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9050 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9051 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9052 numbers and structures.
9053
9054 @item show type
9055 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9056 is setting it automatically.
9057 @end table
9058
9059 @cindex range checking
9060 @cindex checks, range
9061 @node Range Checking
9062 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9063
9064 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9065 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9066 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9067 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9068 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9069
9070 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9071 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9072 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9073 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9074
9075 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9076 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9077 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9078 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9079 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9080 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9081
9082 @smallexample
9083 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9084 @end smallexample
9085
9086 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9087 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9088 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9089
9090 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9091
9092 @kindex set check range
9093 @kindex show check range
9094 @table @code
9095 @item set check range auto
9096 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9097 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9098 each language.
9099
9100 @item set check range on
9101 @itemx set check range off
9102 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9103 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9104 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9105 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9106
9107 @item set check range warn
9108 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9109 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9110 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9111 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9112 systems).
9113
9114 @item show range
9115 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9116 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9117 @end table
9118
9119 @node Supported Languages
9120 @section Supported Languages
9121
9122 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9123 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9124 @c This is false ...
9125 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9126 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9127 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9128 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9129 language.
9130
9131 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9132 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9133 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9134 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9135 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9136 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9137 language reference or tutorial.
9138
9139 @menu
9140 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9141 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9142 * Fortran:: Fortran
9143 * Pascal:: Pascal
9144 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9145 * Ada:: Ada
9146 @end menu
9147
9148 @node C
9149 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9150
9151 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9152 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9153
9154 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9155 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9156 together.
9157
9158 @cindex C@t{++}
9159 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9160 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9161 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9162 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9163 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9164 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9165 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9166
9167 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9168 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9169 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9170 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9171 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9172 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9173
9174 @menu
9175 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9176 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9177 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9178 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9179 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9180 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9181 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9182 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9183 @end menu
9184
9185 @node C Operators
9186 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9187
9188 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9189
9190 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9191 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9192 often defined on groups of types.
9193
9194 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9195
9196 @itemize @bullet
9197
9198 @item
9199 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9200 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9201
9202 @item
9203 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9204 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9205
9206 @item
9207 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9208
9209 @item
9210 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9211
9212 @end itemize
9213
9214 @noindent
9215 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9216 in order of increasing precedence:
9217
9218 @table @code
9219 @item ,
9220 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9221 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9222 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9223
9224 @item =
9225 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9226 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9227
9228 @item @var{op}=
9229 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9230 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9231 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9232 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9233 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9234
9235 @item ?:
9236 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9237 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9238 integral type.
9239
9240 @item ||
9241 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9242
9243 @item &&
9244 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9245
9246 @item |
9247 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9248
9249 @item ^
9250 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9251
9252 @item &
9253 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9254
9255 @item ==@r{, }!=
9256 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9257 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9258
9259 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9260 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9261 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9262 and non-zero for true.
9263
9264 @item <<@r{, }>>
9265 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9266
9267 @item @@
9268 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9269
9270 @item +@r{, }-
9271 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9272 pointer types.
9273
9274 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9275 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9276 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9277 integral types.
9278
9279 @item ++@r{, }--
9280 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9281 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9282 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9283 operation takes place.
9284
9285 @item *
9286 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9287 @code{++}.
9288
9289 @item &
9290 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9291
9292 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9293 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9294 to examine the address
9295 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9296 stored.
9297
9298 @item -
9299 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9300 precedence as @code{++}.
9301
9302 @item !
9303 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9304 @code{++}.
9305
9306 @item ~
9307 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9308 @code{++}.
9309
9310
9311 @item .@r{, }->
9312 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9313 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9314 pointer based on the stored type information.
9315 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9316
9317 @item .*@r{, }->*
9318 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9319
9320 @item []
9321 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9322 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9323
9324 @item ()
9325 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9326
9327 @item ::
9328 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9329 and @code{class} types.
9330
9331 @item ::
9332 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9333 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9334 above.
9335 @end table
9336
9337 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9338 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9339 predefined meaning.
9340
9341 @node C Constants
9342 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9343
9344 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9345
9346 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9347 following ways:
9348
9349 @itemize @bullet
9350 @item
9351 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9352 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9353 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9354 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9355 @code{long} value.
9356
9357 @item
9358 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9359 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9360 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9361 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9362 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9363 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9364 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9365 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9366 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9367 constant.
9368
9369 @item
9370 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9371 integral equivalents.
9372
9373 @item
9374 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9375 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9376 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9377 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9378 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9379 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9380 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9381 @samp{\n} for newline.
9382
9383 @item
9384 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9385 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9386 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9387 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9388 characters.
9389
9390 @item
9391 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9392 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9393
9394 @item
9395 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9396 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9397 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9398 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9399 @end itemize
9400
9401 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9402 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9403
9404 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9405 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9406
9407 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9408 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9409 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9410 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9411 @quotation
9412 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9413 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9414 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9415 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9416 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9417 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9418 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9419 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9420 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9421 C@t{++} code.
9422 @end quotation
9423
9424 @enumerate
9425
9426 @cindex member functions
9427 @item
9428 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9429
9430 @smallexample
9431 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9432 @end smallexample
9433
9434 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9435 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9436 @item
9437 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9438 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9439 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9440 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9441
9442 @cindex call overloaded functions
9443 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9444 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9445 @item
9446 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9447 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9448 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9449 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9450 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9451 default arguments.
9452
9453 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9454 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9455 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9456 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9457 number of function arguments.
9458
9459 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9460 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9461 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9462
9463 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9464 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9465 @smallexample
9466 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9467 @end smallexample
9468
9469 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9470 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9471
9472 @cindex reference declarations
9473 @item
9474 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9475 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9476 dereferenced.
9477
9478 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9479 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9480 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9481 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9482 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9483
9484 @item
9485 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9486 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9487 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9488 necessary, for example in an expression like
9489 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9490 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9491 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9492 @end enumerate
9493
9494 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9495 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9496 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9497 invoking user-defined operators.
9498
9499 @node C Defaults
9500 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9501
9502 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9503
9504 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9505 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9506 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9507 selects the working language.
9508
9509 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9510 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9511 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9512 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9513 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9514 for further details.
9515
9516 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9517 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9518 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9519
9520 @node C Checks
9521 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9522
9523 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9524
9525 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9526 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9527 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9528
9529 @itemize @bullet
9530 @item
9531 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9532 enumerated tag.
9533
9534 @item
9535 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9536 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9537
9538 @ignore
9539 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9540 @c FIXME--beers?
9541 @item
9542 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9543 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9544 compilers.)
9545 @end ignore
9546 @end itemize
9547
9548 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9549 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9550 that is not itself an array.
9551
9552 @node Debugging C
9553 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9554
9555 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9556 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9557 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9558 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9559
9560 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9561 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9562 ,Expressions}.
9563
9564 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9565 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9566
9567 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9568
9569 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9570 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9571
9572 @table @code
9573 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9574 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9575 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9576 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9577 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9578
9579 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9580 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9581 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9582 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9583 classes.
9584 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9585
9586 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9587 @item catch throw
9588 @itemx catch catch
9589 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9590 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9591
9592 @cindex inheritance
9593 @item ptype @var{typename}
9594 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9595 @var{typename}.
9596 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9597
9598 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9599 @item set print demangle
9600 @itemx show print demangle
9601 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9602 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9603 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9604 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9605 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9606
9607 @item set print object
9608 @itemx show print object
9609 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9610 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9611
9612 @item set print vtbl
9613 @itemx show print vtbl
9614 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9615 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9616 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9617 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9618
9619 @kindex set overload-resolution
9620 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9621 @item set overload-resolution on
9622 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9623 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9624 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9625 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9626 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9627 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9628
9629 @item set overload-resolution off
9630 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9631 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9632 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9633 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9634 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9635 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9636 argument types.
9637
9638 @kindex show overload-resolution
9639 @item show overload-resolution
9640 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9641
9642 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9643 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9644 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9645 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9646 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9647 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9648 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9649 @end table
9650
9651 @node Decimal Floating Point
9652 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9653 @cindex decimal floating point format
9654
9655 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9656 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9657 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9658 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9659
9660 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9661 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9662 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9663 target.
9664
9665 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9666 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9667 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9668
9669 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9670 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9671 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9672
9673 @node Objective-C
9674 @subsection Objective-C
9675
9676 @cindex Objective-C
9677 This section provides information about some commands and command
9678 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9679 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9680 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9681
9682 @menu
9683 * Method Names in Commands::
9684 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9685 @end menu
9686
9687 @node Method Names in Commands
9688 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9689
9690 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9691 names as line specifications:
9692
9693 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9694 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9695 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9696 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9697 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9698 @itemize
9699 @item @code{clear}
9700 @item @code{break}
9701 @item @code{info line}
9702 @item @code{jump}
9703 @item @code{list}
9704 @end itemize
9705
9706 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9707
9708 @smallexample
9709 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9710 @end smallexample
9711
9712 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9713 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9714 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9715 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9716 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9717 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9718 debugged, enter:
9719
9720 @smallexample
9721 break -[Fruit create]
9722 @end smallexample
9723
9724 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9725 enter:
9726
9727 @smallexample
9728 list +[NSText initialize]
9729 @end smallexample
9730
9731 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9732 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9733 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9734 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9735
9736 @smallexample
9737 break create
9738 @end smallexample
9739
9740 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9741 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9742 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9743 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9744 none apply.
9745
9746 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9747 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9748
9749 @smallexample
9750 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9751 @end smallexample
9752
9753 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9754 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9755 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9756 @kindex print-object
9757 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9758
9759 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9760
9761 @smallexample
9762 print -[@var{object} hash]
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9766 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9767 @noindent
9768 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9769 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9770 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9771 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9772 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9773 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9774
9775 @node Fortran
9776 @subsection Fortran
9777 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9778
9779 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9780 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9781
9782 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9783 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9784 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9785 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9786 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9787 underscore.
9788
9789 @menu
9790 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9791 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9792 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9793 @end menu
9794
9795 @node Fortran Operators
9796 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9797
9798 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9799
9800 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9801 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9802 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9803
9804 @table @code
9805 @item **
9806 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9807 of the second one.
9808
9809 @item :
9810 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9811 represent a section of array.
9812 @end table
9813
9814 @node Fortran Defaults
9815 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9816
9817 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9818
9819 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9820 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9821 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9822 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9823
9824 @node Special Fortran Commands
9825 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9826
9827 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9828
9829 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9830 such as displaying common blocks.
9831
9832 @table @code
9833 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9834 @kindex info common
9835 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9836 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9837 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9838 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9839 printed.
9840 @end table
9841
9842 @node Pascal
9843 @subsection Pascal
9844
9845 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9846 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9847 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9848 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9849 syntax.
9850
9851 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9852 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9853 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9854
9855 @node Modula-2
9856 @subsection Modula-2
9857
9858 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9859
9860 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9861 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9862 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9863 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9864 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9865 table.
9866
9867 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9868 @menu
9869 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9870 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9871 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9872 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9873 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9874 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9875 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9876 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9877 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9878 @end menu
9879
9880 @node M2 Operators
9881 @subsubsection Operators
9882 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9883
9884 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9885 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9886 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9887 following definitions hold:
9888
9889 @itemize @bullet
9890
9891 @item
9892 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9893 their subranges.
9894
9895 @item
9896 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9897
9898 @item
9899 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9900
9901 @item
9902 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9903 @var{type}}.
9904
9905 @item
9906 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9907
9908 @item
9909 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9910
9911 @item
9912 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9913 @end itemize
9914
9915 @noindent
9916 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9917 increasing precedence:
9918
9919 @table @code
9920 @item ,
9921 Function argument or array index separator.
9922
9923 @item :=
9924 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9925 @var{value}.
9926
9927 @item <@r{, }>
9928 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9929 types.
9930
9931 @item <=@r{, }>=
9932 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9933 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9934 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9935
9936 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9937 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9938 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9939 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9940 comment character.
9941
9942 @item IN
9943 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9944 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9945
9946 @item OR
9947 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9948
9949 @item AND@r{, }&
9950 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9951
9952 @item @@
9953 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9954
9955 @item +@r{, }-
9956 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9957 and difference on set types.
9958
9959 @item *
9960 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9961 on set types.
9962
9963 @item /
9964 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9965 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9966
9967 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9968 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9969 precedence as @code{*}.
9970
9971 @item -
9972 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9973
9974 @item ^
9975 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9976
9977 @item NOT
9978 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9979 @code{^}.
9980
9981 @item .
9982 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9983 precedence as @code{^}.
9984
9985 @item []
9986 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9987
9988 @item ()
9989 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9990 as @code{^}.
9991
9992 @item ::@r{, }.
9993 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9994 @end table
9995
9996 @quotation
9997 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9998 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9999 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10000 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10001 @end quotation
10002
10003
10004 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10005 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10006 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10007
10008 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10009 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10010
10011 @table @var
10012
10013 @item a
10014 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10015
10016 @item c
10017 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10018
10019 @item i
10020 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10021
10022 @item m
10023 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10024 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10025 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10026
10027 @item n
10028 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10029
10030 @item r
10031 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10032
10033 @item t
10034 represents a type.
10035
10036 @item v
10037 represents a variable.
10038
10039 @item x
10040 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10041 explanation of the function for details.
10042 @end table
10043
10044 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10045
10046 @table @code
10047 @item ABS(@var{n})
10048 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10049
10050 @item CAP(@var{c})
10051 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10052 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10053
10054 @item CHR(@var{i})
10055 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10056
10057 @item DEC(@var{v})
10058 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10059
10060 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10061 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10062 new value.
10063
10064 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10065 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10066 set.
10067
10068 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10069 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10070
10071 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10072 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10073
10074 @item INC(@var{v})
10075 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10076
10077 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10078 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10079 new value.
10080
10081 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10082 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10083 there. Returns the new set.
10084
10085 @item MAX(@var{t})
10086 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10087
10088 @item MIN(@var{t})
10089 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10090
10091 @item ODD(@var{i})
10092 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10093
10094 @item ORD(@var{x})
10095 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10096 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10097 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10098 integral, character and enumerated types.
10099
10100 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10101 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10102
10103 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10104 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10105
10106 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10107 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10108
10109 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10110 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10111 @end table
10112
10113 @quotation
10114 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10115 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10116 an error.
10117 @end quotation
10118
10119 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10120 @node M2 Constants
10121 @subsubsection Constants
10122
10123 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10124 ways:
10125
10126 @itemize @bullet
10127
10128 @item
10129 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10130 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10131 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10132 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10133
10134 @item
10135 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10136 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10137 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10138 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10139 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10140 digits.
10141
10142 @item
10143 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10144 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10145 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10146 followed by a @samp{C}.
10147
10148 @item
10149 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10150 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10151 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10152 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10153 sequences.
10154
10155 @item
10156 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10157
10158 @item
10159 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10160 @code{FALSE}.
10161
10162 @item
10163 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10164
10165 @item
10166 Set constants are not yet supported.
10167 @end itemize
10168
10169 @node M2 Types
10170 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10171 @cindex Modula-2 types
10172
10173 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10174 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10175 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10176 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10177 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10178 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10179
10180 The first example contains the following section of code:
10181
10182 @smallexample
10183 VAR
10184 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10185 r: [20..40] ;
10186 @end smallexample
10187
10188 @noindent
10189 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10190 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10191
10192 @smallexample
10193 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10194 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10195 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10196 SET OF CHAR
10197 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10198 21
10199 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10200 [20..40]
10201 @end smallexample
10202
10203 @noindent
10204 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10205
10206 @smallexample
10207 VAR
10208 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10209 @end smallexample
10210
10211 @noindent
10212 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10213
10214 @smallexample
10215 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10216 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10217 @end smallexample
10218
10219 @noindent
10220 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10221 expressions using the debugger.
10222
10223 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10224 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10225
10226 @smallexample
10227 VAR
10228 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10229 @end smallexample
10230
10231 @smallexample
10232 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10233 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10234 @end smallexample
10235
10236 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10237 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10238 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10239 above.
10240
10241 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10242
10243 @smallexample
10244 TYPE
10245 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10246 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10247 VAR
10248 s: t ;
10249 BEGIN
10250 s := blue ;
10251 @end smallexample
10252
10253 @noindent
10254 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10255 and value of a variable.
10256
10257 @smallexample
10258 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10259 $1 = blue
10260 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10261 type = [blue..yellow]
10262 @end smallexample
10263
10264 @noindent
10265 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10266 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10267 their @code{C} counterparts.
10268
10269 @smallexample
10270 VAR
10271 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10272 BEGIN
10273 s[1] := 1 ;
10274 @end smallexample
10275
10276 @smallexample
10277 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10278 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10279 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10280 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10281 @end smallexample
10282
10283 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10284 pointer types as shown in this example:
10285
10286 @smallexample
10287 VAR
10288 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10289 BEGIN
10290 NEW(s) ;
10291 s^[1] := 1 ;
10292 @end smallexample
10293
10294 @noindent
10295 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10296
10297 @smallexample
10298 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10299 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10300 @end smallexample
10301
10302 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10303 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10304 types:
10305
10306 @smallexample
10307 TYPE
10308 foo = RECORD
10309 f1: CARDINAL ;
10310 f2: CHAR ;
10311 f3: myarray ;
10312 END ;
10313
10314 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10315 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10316 VAR
10317 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10318 @end smallexample
10319
10320 @noindent
10321 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10322 below.
10323
10324 @smallexample
10325 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10326 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10327 f1 : CARDINAL;
10328 f2 : CHAR;
10329 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10330 END
10331 @end smallexample
10332
10333 @node M2 Defaults
10334 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10335 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10336
10337 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10338 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10339 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10340 selected the working language.
10341
10342 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10343 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10344 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10345 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10346
10347 @node Deviations
10348 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10349 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10350
10351 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10352 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10353
10354 @itemize @bullet
10355 @item
10356 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10357 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10358 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10359 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10360 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10361 returned a pointer.)
10362
10363 @item
10364 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10365 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10366 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10367 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10368
10369 @item
10370 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10371 argument.
10372
10373 @item
10374 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10375 @end itemize
10376
10377 @node M2 Checks
10378 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10379 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10380
10381 @quotation
10382 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10383 range checking.
10384 @end quotation
10385 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10386
10387 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10388
10389 @itemize @bullet
10390 @item
10391 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10392 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10393
10394 @item
10395 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10396 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10397 @end itemize
10398
10399 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10400 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10401
10402 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10403 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10404
10405 @node M2 Scope
10406 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10407 @cindex scope
10408 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10409 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10410 @ifinfo
10411 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10412 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10413 @end ifinfo
10414 @iftex
10415 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10416 @end iftex
10417
10418 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10419 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10420 similar syntax:
10421
10422 @smallexample
10423
10424 @var{module} . @var{id}
10425 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10426 @end smallexample
10427
10428 @noindent
10429 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10430 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10431 identifier within your program, except another module.
10432
10433 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10434 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10435 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10436 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10437
10438 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10439 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10440 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10441 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10442 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10443 @var{module}.
10444
10445 @node GDB/M2
10446 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10447
10448 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10449 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10450 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10451 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10452 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10453 analogue in Modula-2.
10454
10455 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10456 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10457 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10458 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10459 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10460 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10461
10462 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10463 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10464 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10465
10466 @node Ada
10467 @subsection Ada
10468 @cindex Ada
10469
10470 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10471 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10472 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10473 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10474 to be difficult.
10475
10476
10477 @cindex expressions in Ada
10478 @menu
10479 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10480 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10481 in @value{GDBN}.
10482 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10483 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10484 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10485 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10486 @end menu
10487
10488 @node Ada Mode Intro
10489 @subsubsection Introduction
10490 @cindex Ada mode, general
10491
10492 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10493 syntax, with some extensions.
10494 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10495
10496 @itemize @bullet
10497 @item
10498 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10499 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10500 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10501 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10502
10503 @item
10504 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10505 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10506
10507 @item
10508 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10509 @end itemize
10510
10511 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10512 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10513 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10514 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10515 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10516
10517 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10518 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10519 was translated from an Ada source file.
10520
10521 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10522 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10523 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10524 middle (to allow based literals).
10525
10526 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10527 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10528 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10529 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10530 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10531 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10532
10533 @node Omissions from Ada
10534 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10535 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10536
10537 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10538
10539 @itemize @bullet
10540 @item
10541 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10542
10543 @itemize @minus
10544 @item
10545 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10546 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10547
10548 @item
10549 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10550
10551 @item
10552 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10553
10554 @item
10555 @t{'Tag}.
10556
10557 @item
10558 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10559 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10560
10561 @item
10562 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10563 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10564
10565 @item
10566 @t{'Address}.
10567 @end itemize
10568
10569 @item
10570 The names in
10571 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10572 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10573 not currently available.
10574
10575 @item
10576 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10577 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10578 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10579 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10580 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10581 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10582 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10583 indeterminate values.
10584
10585 @item
10586 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10587 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10588 are not implemented.
10589
10590 @item
10591 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10592 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10593 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10594 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10595 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10596
10597 @smallexample
10598 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10599 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10600 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10601 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10602 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10603 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10604 @end smallexample
10605
10606 Changing a
10607 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10608 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10609 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10610 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10611 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10612 declared to have a type such as:
10613
10614 @smallexample
10615 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10616 Id : Integer;
10617 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10618 end record;
10619 @end smallexample
10620
10621 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10622 assignments:
10623
10624 @smallexample
10625 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10626 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10627 @end smallexample
10628
10629 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10630 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10631 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10632 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10633 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10634 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10635 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10636 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10637
10638 @item
10639 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10640
10641 @item
10642 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10643 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10644 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10645 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10646 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10647 the proper resolution.
10648
10649 @item
10650 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10651
10652 @item
10653 Entry calls are not implemented.
10654
10655 @item
10656 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10657 formats are not supported.
10658
10659 @item
10660 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10661 @end itemize
10662
10663 @node Additions to Ada
10664 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10665 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10666
10667 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10668 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10669
10670 @itemize @bullet
10671 @item
10672 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10673 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10674 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10675 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10676 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10677 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10678 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10679 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10680
10681 @item
10682 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10683 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10684 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10685
10686 @item
10687 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10688 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10689
10690 @item
10691 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10692 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10693 @end itemize
10694
10695 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10696 additions specific to Ada:
10697
10698 @itemize @bullet
10699 @item
10700 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10701 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10702
10703 @smallexample
10704 set x := y + 3
10705 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10706 @end smallexample
10707
10708 @item
10709 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10710 the value of its right-hand operand.
10711 This allows, for example,
10712 complex conditional breaks:
10713
10714 @smallexample
10715 break f
10716 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10717 @end smallexample
10718
10719 @item
10720 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10721 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10722 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10723 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10724 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10725 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10726 in strings. For example,
10727 @smallexample
10728 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10729 @end smallexample
10730 @noindent
10731 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10732 after each period.
10733
10734 @item
10735 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10736 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10737 to write
10738
10739 @smallexample
10740 print 'max(x, y)
10741 @end smallexample
10742
10743 @item
10744 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10745 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10746 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10747 of 3 might print as
10748
10749 @smallexample
10750 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10751 @end smallexample
10752
10753 @noindent
10754 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10755 clause.
10756
10757 @item
10758 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10759 multi-character subsequence of
10760 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10761 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10762 in place of @t{a'length}.
10763
10764 @item
10765 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10766 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10767 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10768 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10769 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10770 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10771 For example,
10772 @smallexample
10773 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10774 @end smallexample
10775
10776 @item
10777 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10778 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10779 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10780 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10781 object.
10782
10783 @end itemize
10784
10785 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10786 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10787
10788 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10789 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10790 before reaching the main procedure.
10791 As defined in the Ada Reference
10792 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10793 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10794 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10795 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10796
10797 @node Ada Glitches
10798 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10799 @cindex Ada, problems
10800
10801 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10802 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10803 @value{GDBN},
10804 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10805 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10806
10807 @itemize @bullet
10808 @item
10809 Currently, the debugger
10810 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10811 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10812 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10813 to get it printed properly.
10814
10815 @item
10816 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10817 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10818
10819 @item
10820 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10821 argument lists are treated as positional).
10822
10823 @item
10824 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10825
10826 @item
10827 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10828 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10829 the host machine.
10830
10831 @item
10832 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10833
10834 @item
10835 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10836 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10837 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10838 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10839 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10840 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10841 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10842 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10843 you can usually resolve the confusion
10844 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10845 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10846 @end itemize
10847
10848 @node Unsupported Languages
10849 @section Unsupported Languages
10850
10851 @cindex unsupported languages
10852 @cindex minimal language
10853 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10854 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10855 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10856 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10857 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10858 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10859
10860 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10861 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10862 language.
10863
10864 @node Symbols
10865 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10866
10867 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10868 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10869 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10870 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10871 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10872 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10873 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10874
10875 @cindex symbol names
10876 @cindex names of symbols
10877 @cindex quoting names
10878 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10879 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10880 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10881 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10882 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10883 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10884 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10885 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10886
10887 @smallexample
10888 p 'foo.c'::x
10889 @end smallexample
10890
10891 @noindent
10892 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10893
10894 @table @code
10895 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10896 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10897 @kindex set case-sensitive
10898 @item set case-sensitive on
10899 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10900 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10901 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10902 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10903 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10904 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10905 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10906 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10907 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10908 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10909 case-insensitive matches.
10910
10911 @kindex show case-sensitive
10912 @item show case-sensitive
10913 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10914 lookups.
10915
10916 @kindex info address
10917 @cindex address of a symbol
10918 @item info address @var{symbol}
10919 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10920 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10921 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10922 is always stored.
10923
10924 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10925 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10926 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10927
10928 @kindex info symbol
10929 @cindex symbol from address
10930 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10931 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10932 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10933 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10934 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10935
10936 @smallexample
10937 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10938 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 @noindent
10942 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10943 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10944
10945 @kindex whatis
10946 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10947 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10948 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10949 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10950 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10951 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10952 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10953 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10954 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10955 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10956 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10957
10958 @kindex ptype
10959 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10960 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10961 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10962 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10963
10964 For example, for this variable declaration:
10965
10966 @smallexample
10967 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10968 @end smallexample
10969
10970 @noindent
10971 the two commands give this output:
10972
10973 @smallexample
10974 @group
10975 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10976 type = struct complex
10977 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10978 type = struct complex @{
10979 double real;
10980 double imag;
10981 @}
10982 @end group
10983 @end smallexample
10984
10985 @noindent
10986 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10987 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10988
10989 @cindex incomplete type
10990 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10991 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10992 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10993 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10994 given these declarations:
10995
10996 @smallexample
10997 struct foo;
10998 struct foo *fooptr;
10999 @end smallexample
11000
11001 @noindent
11002 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11003
11004 @smallexample
11005 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11006 $1 = <incomplete type>
11007 @end smallexample
11008
11009 @noindent
11010 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11011 completely specified.
11012
11013 @kindex info types
11014 @item info types @var{regexp}
11015 @itemx info types
11016 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11017 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11018 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11019 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11020 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11021 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11022 name is @code{value}.
11023
11024 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11025 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11026 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11027
11028 @kindex info scope
11029 @cindex local variables
11030 @item info scope @var{location}
11031 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11032 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11033 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11034 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11035 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11036
11037 @smallexample
11038 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11039 Scope for command_line_handler:
11040 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11041 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11042 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11043 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11044 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11045 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11046 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11047 @end smallexample
11048
11049 @noindent
11050 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11051 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11052 collect}.
11053
11054 @kindex info source
11055 @item info source
11056 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11057 the function containing the current point of execution:
11058 @itemize @bullet
11059 @item
11060 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11061 @item
11062 the directory it was compiled in,
11063 @item
11064 its length, in lines,
11065 @item
11066 which programming language it is written in,
11067 @item
11068 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11069 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11070 @item
11071 whether the debugging information includes information about
11072 preprocessor macros.
11073 @end itemize
11074
11075
11076 @kindex info sources
11077 @item info sources
11078 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11079 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11080 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11081
11082 @kindex info functions
11083 @item info functions
11084 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11085
11086 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11087 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11088 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11089 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11090 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11091 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11092 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11093 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11094
11095 @kindex info variables
11096 @item info variables
11097 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11098 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11099
11100 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11101 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11102 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11103 @var{regexp}.
11104
11105 @kindex info classes
11106 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11107 @item info classes
11108 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11109 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11110 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11111 expression.
11112
11113 @kindex info selectors
11114 @item info selectors
11115 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11116 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11117 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11118 expression.
11119
11120 @ignore
11121 This was never implemented.
11122 @kindex info methods
11123 @item info methods
11124 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11125 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11126 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11127 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11128 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11129 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11130 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11131 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11132 @end ignore
11133
11134 @cindex reloading symbols
11135 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11136 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11137 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11138 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11139 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11140
11141 @table @code
11142 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11143 @item set symbol-reloading on
11144 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11145 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11146
11147 @item set symbol-reloading off
11148 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11149 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11150 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11151 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11152 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11153 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11154 name.
11155
11156 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11157 @item show symbol-reloading
11158 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11159 @end table
11160
11161 @cindex opaque data types
11162 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11163 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11164 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11165 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11166 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11167 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11168 another source file. The default is on.
11169
11170 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11171 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11172
11173 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11174 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11175 is printed as follows:
11176 @smallexample
11177 @{<no data fields>@}
11178 @end smallexample
11179
11180 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11181 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11182 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11183
11184 @kindex maint print symbols
11185 @cindex symbol dump
11186 @kindex maint print psymbols
11187 @cindex partial symbol dump
11188 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11189 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11190 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11191 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11192 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11193 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11194 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11195 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11196 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11197 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11198 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11199 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11200 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11201 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11202 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11203 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11204 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11205
11206 @kindex maint info symtabs
11207 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11208 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11209 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11210 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11211 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11212 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11213 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11214
11215 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11216 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11217 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11218 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11219 structure in more detail. For example:
11220
11221 @smallexample
11222 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11223 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11224 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11225 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11226 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11227 readin no
11228 fullname (null)
11229 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11230 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11231 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11232 dependencies (none)
11233 @}
11234 @}
11235 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11236 (@value{GDBP})
11237 @end smallexample
11238 @noindent
11239 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11240 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11241 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11242 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11243 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11244
11245 @smallexample
11246 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11247 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11248 line 1574.
11249 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11250 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11251 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11252 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11253 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11254 dirname (null)
11255 fullname (null)
11256 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11257 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11258 debugformat DWARF 2
11259 @}
11260 @}
11261 (@value{GDBP})
11262 @end smallexample
11263 @end table
11264
11265
11266 @node Altering
11267 @chapter Altering Execution
11268
11269 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11270 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11271 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11272 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11273 program.
11274
11275 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11276 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11277 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11278
11279 @menu
11280 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11281 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11282 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11283 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11284 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11285 * Patching:: Patching your program
11286 @end menu
11287
11288 @node Assignment
11289 @section Assignment to Variables
11290
11291 @cindex assignment
11292 @cindex setting variables
11293 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11294 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11295
11296 @smallexample
11297 print x=4
11298 @end smallexample
11299
11300 @noindent
11301 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11302 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11303 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11304 information on operators in supported languages.
11305
11306 @kindex set variable
11307 @cindex variables, setting
11308 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11309 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11310 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11311 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11312 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11313
11314 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11315 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11316 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11317 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11318 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11319 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11320 command @code{set width}:
11321
11322 @smallexample
11323 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11324 type = double
11325 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11326 $4 = 13
11327 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11328 Invalid syntax in expression.
11329 @end smallexample
11330
11331 @noindent
11332 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11333 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11334
11335 @smallexample
11336 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11337 @end smallexample
11338
11339 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11340 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11341 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11342 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11343 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11344 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11345
11346 @smallexample
11347 @group
11348 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11349 type = double
11350 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11351 $1 = 1
11352 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11353 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11354 $2 = 1
11355 (@value{GDBP}) r
11356 The program being debugged has been started already.
11357 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11358 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11359 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11360 Invalid bfd target.
11361 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11362 The current BFD target is "=4".
11363 @end group
11364 @end smallexample
11365
11366 @noindent
11367 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11368 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11369 @code{g}, use
11370
11371 @smallexample
11372 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11373 @end smallexample
11374
11375 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11376 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11377 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11378 same length or shorter.
11379 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11380 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11381
11382 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11383 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11384 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11385 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11386 and representation in memory), and
11387
11388 @smallexample
11389 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11390 @end smallexample
11391
11392 @noindent
11393 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11394
11395 @node Jumping
11396 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11397
11398 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11399 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11400 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11401
11402 @table @code
11403 @kindex jump
11404 @item jump @var{linespec}
11405 @itemx jump @var{location}
11406 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11407 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11408 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11409 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11410 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11411 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11412
11413 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11414 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11415 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11416 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11417 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11418 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11419 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11420 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11421 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11422 @end table
11423
11424 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11425 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11426 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11427 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11428 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11429 example,
11430
11431 @smallexample
11432 set $pc = 0x485
11433 @end smallexample
11434
11435 @noindent
11436 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11437 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11438 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11439
11440 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11441 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11442 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11443 detail.
11444
11445 @c @group
11446 @node Signaling
11447 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11448 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11449
11450 @table @code
11451 @kindex signal
11452 @item signal @var{signal}
11453 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11454 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11455 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11456 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11457
11458 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11459 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11460 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11461 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11462 signal.
11463
11464 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11465 after executing the command.
11466 @end table
11467 @c @end group
11468
11469 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11470 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11471 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11472 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11473 passes the signal directly to your program.
11474
11475
11476 @node Returning
11477 @section Returning from a Function
11478
11479 @table @code
11480 @cindex returning from a function
11481 @kindex return
11482 @item return
11483 @itemx return @var{expression}
11484 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11485 command. If you give an
11486 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11487 value.
11488 @end table
11489
11490 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11491 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11492 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11493 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11494
11495 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11496 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11497 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11498 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11499 of functions.
11500
11501 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11502 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11503 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11504 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11505 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11506
11507 @node Calling
11508 @section Calling Program Functions
11509
11510 @table @code
11511 @cindex calling functions
11512 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11513 @item print @var{expr}
11514 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11515 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11516 debugged.
11517
11518 @kindex call
11519 @item call @var{expr}
11520 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11521 returned values.
11522
11523 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11524 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11525 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11526 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11527 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11528 value history.
11529 @end table
11530
11531 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11532 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11533 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11534 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11535
11536 @table @code
11537 @item set unwindonsignal
11538 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11539 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11540 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11541 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11542 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11543 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11544 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11545 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11546 received.
11547
11548 @item show unwindonsignal
11549 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11550 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11551 @value{GDBN}.
11552 @end table
11553
11554 @cindex weak alias functions
11555 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11556 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11557 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11558 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11559 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11560 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11561 function instead.
11562
11563 @node Patching
11564 @section Patching Programs
11565
11566 @cindex patching binaries
11567 @cindex writing into executables
11568 @cindex writing into corefiles
11569
11570 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11571 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11572 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11573 patching your program's binary.
11574
11575 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11576 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11577 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11578 repairs.
11579
11580 @table @code
11581 @kindex set write
11582 @item set write on
11583 @itemx set write off
11584 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11585 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11586 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11587
11588 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11589 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11590 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11591
11592 @item show write
11593 @kindex show write
11594 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11595 as well as reading.
11596 @end table
11597
11598 @node GDB Files
11599 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11600
11601 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11602 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11603 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11604 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11605
11606 @menu
11607 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11608 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11609 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11610 @end menu
11611
11612 @node Files
11613 @section Commands to Specify Files
11614
11615 @cindex symbol table
11616 @cindex core dump file
11617
11618 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11619 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11620 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11621 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11622
11623 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11624 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11625 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11626 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11627 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11628 new files are useful.
11629
11630 @table @code
11631 @cindex executable file
11632 @kindex file
11633 @item file @var{filename}
11634 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11635 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11636 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11637 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11638 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11639 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11640 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11641 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11642
11643 @cindex unlinked object files
11644 @cindex patching object files
11645 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11646 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11647 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11648 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11649 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11650 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11651 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11652 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11653
11654 @item file
11655 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11656 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11657
11658 @kindex exec-file
11659 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11660 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11661 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11662 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11663 discard information on the executable file.
11664
11665 @kindex symbol-file
11666 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11667 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11668 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11669 table and program to run from the same file.
11670
11671 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11672 program's symbol table.
11673
11674 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11675 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11676 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11677 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11678 @value{GDBN}.
11679
11680 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11681 executing it once.
11682
11683 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11684 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11685 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11686 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11687 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11688 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11689 optimized code.
11690
11691 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11692 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11693 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11694 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11695 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11696
11697 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11698 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11699 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11700 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11701 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11702 Warnings and Messages}.)
11703
11704 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11705 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11706 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11707 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11708 in stabs format.
11709
11710 @kindex readnow
11711 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11712 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11713 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11714 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11715 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11716 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11717 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11718 entire symbol table available.
11719
11720 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11721 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11722 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11723 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11724 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11725 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11726 @c files.
11727
11728 @kindex core-file
11729 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11730 @itemx core
11731 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11732 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11733 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11734 executable file itself for other parts.
11735
11736 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11737 to be used.
11738
11739 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11740 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11741 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11742 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11743 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11744
11745 @kindex add-symbol-file
11746 @cindex dynamic linking
11747 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11748 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11749 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11750 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11751 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11752 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11753 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11754 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11755 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11756 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11757 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11758 @var{address} as an expression.
11759
11760 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11761 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11762 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11763 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11764 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11765
11766 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11767 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11768 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11769 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11770 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11771 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11772 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11773 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11774 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11775
11776 @itemize @bullet
11777 @item
11778 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11779 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11780 @item
11781 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11782 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11783 @item
11784 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11785 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11786 @end itemize
11787
11788 @noindent
11789 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11790 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11791 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11792 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11793 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11794 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11795 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11796 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11797 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11798 way.
11799
11800 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11801
11802 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11803 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11804 @cindex load symbols from memory
11805 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11806 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11807 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11808 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11809 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11810 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11811 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11812 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11813 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11814
11815 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11816 @kindex assf
11817 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11818 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11819 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11820 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11821 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11822 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11823 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11824 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11825 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11826 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11827
11828 @kindex section
11829 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11830 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11831 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11832 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11833 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11834 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11835 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11836 their addresses.
11837
11838 @kindex info files
11839 @kindex info target
11840 @item info files
11841 @itemx info target
11842 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11843 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11844 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11845 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11846 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11847 current ones.
11848
11849 @kindex maint info sections
11850 @item maint info sections
11851 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11852 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11853 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11854 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11855 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11856 may be arbitrarily combined):
11857
11858 @table @code
11859 @item ALLOBJ
11860 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11861 @item @var{sections}
11862 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11863 @item @var{section-flags}
11864 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11865 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11866 @table @code
11867 @item ALLOC
11868 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11869 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11870 @item LOAD
11871 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11872 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11873 @item RELOC
11874 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11875 @item READONLY
11876 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11877 @item CODE
11878 Section contains executable code only.
11879 @item DATA
11880 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11881 @item ROM
11882 Section will reside in ROM.
11883 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11884 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11885 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11886 Section is not empty.
11887 @item NEVER_LOAD
11888 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11889 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11890 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11891 COFF shared library information.
11892 @item IS_COMMON
11893 Section contains common symbols.
11894 @end table
11895 @end table
11896 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11897 @cindex read-only sections
11898 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11899 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11900 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11901 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11902 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11903 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11904 enhancement to debugging performance.
11905
11906 The default is off.
11907
11908 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11909 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11910 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11911 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11912
11913 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11914 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11915 @end table
11916
11917 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11918 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11919 name and remembers it that way.
11920
11921 @cindex shared libraries
11922 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
11923 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11924 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11925
11926 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11927 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11928
11929 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11930 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11931 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11932 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11933 debugging a core file).
11934
11935 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11936 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11937
11938 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11939 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11940 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11941
11942 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11943 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11944 particularly large or there are many of them.
11945
11946 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11947 commands:
11948
11949 @table @code
11950 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11951 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11952 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11953 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11954 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11955 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11956 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11957 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11958
11959 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11960 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11961 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11962 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11963 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11964 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11965 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11966 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11967 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11968
11969 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11970 @item show auto-solib-add
11971 Display the current autoloading mode.
11972 @end table
11973
11974 @cindex load shared library
11975 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11976 command:
11977
11978 @table @code
11979 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11980 @kindex info share
11981 @item info share
11982 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11983 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11984
11985 @kindex sharedlibrary
11986 @kindex share
11987 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11988 @itemx share @var{regex}
11989 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11990 Unix regular expression.
11991 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11992 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11993 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11994 loaded.
11995
11996 @item nosharedlibrary
11997 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11998 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11999 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12000 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12001 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12002 discarded.
12003 @end table
12004
12005 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12006 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12007 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12008
12009 @table @code
12010 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12011 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12012 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12013 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12014 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12015 shared library.
12016
12017 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12018 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12019 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12020 library events happen.
12021 @end table
12022
12023 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12024 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12025 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12026 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12027 not.
12028
12029 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12030 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12031 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12032 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12033 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12034
12035 @table @code
12036 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12037 @cindex system root, alternate
12038 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12039 @kindex set sysroot
12040 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12041 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12042 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12043 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12044 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12045 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12046 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12047 under @var{path}.
12048
12049 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12050 sysroot}.
12051
12052 @cindex default system root
12053 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12054 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12055 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12056 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12057 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12058 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12059 location.
12060
12061 @kindex show sysroot
12062 @item show sysroot
12063 Display the current shared library prefix.
12064
12065 @kindex set solib-search-path
12066 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12067 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12068 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12069 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12070 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12071 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12072 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12073 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12074 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12075 of shared library symbols.
12076
12077 @kindex show solib-search-path
12078 @item show solib-search-path
12079 Display the current shared library search path.
12080 @end table
12081
12082
12083 @node Separate Debug Files
12084 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12085 @cindex separate debugging information files
12086 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12087 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12088 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12089 @cindex global debugging information directory
12090 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12091 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12092
12093 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12094 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12095 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12096 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12097 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12098 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12099 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12100
12101 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12102 file:
12103
12104 @itemize @bullet
12105 @item
12106 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12107 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12108 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12109 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12110 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12111 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12112 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12113 came from the same build.
12114
12115 @item
12116 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12117 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12118 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12119 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12120 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12121 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12122 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12123 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12124 below.
12125 @end itemize
12126
12127 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12128 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12129
12130 @itemize @bullet
12131 @item
12132 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12133 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12134 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12135 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12136 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12137
12138 @item
12139 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12140 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12141 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12142 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12143 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12144 hex characters, not 10.)
12145 @end itemize
12146
12147 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12148 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12149 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12150 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12151 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12152 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12153
12154 @itemize @minus
12155 @item
12156 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12157 @item
12158 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12159 @item
12160 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12161 @item
12162 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12163 @end itemize
12164
12165 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12166 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12167
12168 @table @code
12169
12170 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12171 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12172 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12173 information files to @var{directory}.
12174
12175 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12176 @item show debug-file-directory
12177 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12178 information files.
12179
12180 @end table
12181
12182 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12183 @cindex debug link sections
12184 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12185 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12186
12187 @itemize
12188 @item
12189 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12190 a zero byte,
12191 @item
12192 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12193 boundary within the section, and
12194 @item
12195 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12196 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12197 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12198 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12199 @end itemize
12200
12201 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12202 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12203 described above.
12204
12205 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12206 @cindex build ID sections
12207 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12208 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12209 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12210 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12211 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12212 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12213 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12214 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12215 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12216
12217 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12218 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12219 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12220 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12221 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12222 in an ordinary executable.
12223
12224 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12225 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12226 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12227 following commands:
12228
12229 @smallexample
12230 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12231 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12232 @end smallexample
12233
12234 @noindent
12235 These commands remove the debugging
12236 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12237 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12238 two files:
12239
12240 @itemize @bullet
12241 @item
12242 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12243 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12244
12245 @smallexample
12246 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12247 @end smallexample
12248
12249 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12250 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12251 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12252 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12253
12254 @item
12255 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12256 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12257 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12258 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12259 @end itemize
12260
12261 @noindent
12262
12263 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12264 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12265 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12266 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12267
12268 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12269 @smallexample
12270 unsigned long
12271 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12272 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12273 @{
12274 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12275 @{
12276 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12277 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12278 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12279 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12280 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12281 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12282 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12283 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12284 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12285 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12286 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12287 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12288 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12289 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12290 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12291 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12292 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12293 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12294 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12295 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12296 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12297 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12298 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12299 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12300 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12301 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12302 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12303 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12304 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12305 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12306 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12307 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12308 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12309 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12310 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12311 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12312 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12313 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12314 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12315 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12316 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12317 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12318 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12319 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12320 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12321 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12322 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12323 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12324 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12325 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12326 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12327 0x2d02ef8d
12328 @};
12329 unsigned char *end;
12330
12331 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12332 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12333 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12334 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12335 @}
12336 @end smallexample
12337
12338 @noindent
12339 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12340
12341
12342 @node Symbol Errors
12343 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12344
12345 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12346 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12347 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12348 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12349 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12350 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12351 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12352 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12353 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12354 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12355 Messages}).
12356
12357 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12358
12359 @table @code
12360 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12361
12362 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12363 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12364 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12365 in its outer scope blocks.
12366
12367 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12368 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12369 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12370 function.
12371
12372 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12373
12374 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12375 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12376 do so.
12377
12378 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12379 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12380 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12381 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12382 Messages}.)
12383
12384 @item bad block start address patched
12385
12386 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12387 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12388 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12389
12390 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12391 starting on the previous source line.
12392
12393 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12394
12395 @cindex foo
12396 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12397 larger than the size of the string table.
12398
12399 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12400 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12401 with this name.
12402
12403 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12404
12405 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12406 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12407 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12408
12409 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12410 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12411 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12412 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12413 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12414 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12415
12416 @item stub type has NULL name
12417
12418 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12419
12420 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12421 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12422 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12423 it.
12424
12425 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12426
12427 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12428
12429 @end table
12430
12431 @node Targets
12432 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12433
12434 @cindex debugging target
12435 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12436
12437 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12438 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12439 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12440 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12441 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12442 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12443 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12444 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12445
12446 @cindex target architecture
12447 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12448 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12449 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12450 command.
12451
12452 @table @code
12453 @kindex set architecture
12454 @kindex show architecture
12455 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12456 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12457 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12458 supported architectures.
12459
12460 @item show architecture
12461 Show the current target architecture.
12462
12463 @item set processor
12464 @itemx processor
12465 @kindex set processor
12466 @kindex show processor
12467 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12468 and @code{show architecture}.
12469 @end table
12470
12471 @menu
12472 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12473 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12474 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12475 @end menu
12476
12477 @node Active Targets
12478 @section Active Targets
12479
12480 @cindex stacking targets
12481 @cindex active targets
12482 @cindex multiple targets
12483
12484 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12485 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12486 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12487 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12488 a core file.
12489
12490 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12491 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12492 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12493 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12494 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12495 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12496 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12497 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12498 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12499
12500 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12501 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12502 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12503 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12504 process target is active.
12505
12506 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12507 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12508 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12509 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12510 Process}).
12511
12512 @node Target Commands
12513 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12514
12515 @table @code
12516 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12517 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12518 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12519 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12520 protocol of the target machine.
12521
12522 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12523 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12524 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12525
12526 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12527 after executing the command.
12528
12529 @kindex help target
12530 @item help target
12531 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12532 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12533 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12534
12535 @item help target @var{name}
12536 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12537 select it.
12538
12539 @kindex set gnutarget
12540 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12541 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12542 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12543 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12544 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12545 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12546
12547 @quotation
12548 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12549 you must know the actual BFD name.
12550 @end quotation
12551
12552 @noindent
12553 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12554
12555 @kindex show gnutarget
12556 @item show gnutarget
12557 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12558 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12559 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12560 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12561 @end table
12562
12563 @cindex common targets
12564 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12565 configuration):
12566
12567 @table @code
12568 @kindex target
12569 @item target exec @var{program}
12570 @cindex executable file target
12571 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12572 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12573
12574 @item target core @var{filename}
12575 @cindex core dump file target
12576 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12577 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12578
12579 @item target remote @var{medium}
12580 @cindex remote target
12581 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12582 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12583 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12584
12585 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12586 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12587
12588 @smallexample
12589 target remote /dev/ttya
12590 @end smallexample
12591
12592 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12593 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12594 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12595 clobbered by the download.
12596
12597 @item target sim
12598 @cindex built-in simulator target
12599 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12600 In general,
12601 @smallexample
12602 target sim
12603 load
12604 run
12605 @end smallexample
12606 @noindent
12607 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12608 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12609 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12610 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12611 Processors}.
12612
12613 @end table
12614
12615 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12616
12617 @table @code
12618
12619 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12620 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12621 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12622
12623 @end table
12624
12625 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12626 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12627
12628 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12629 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12630 various aspects of this process.
12631
12632 @table @code
12633
12634 @item set hash
12635 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12636 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12637 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12638 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12639 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12640 monitor.
12641
12642 @item show hash
12643 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12644 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12645
12646 @item set debug monitor
12647 @kindex set debug monitor
12648 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12649 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12650 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12651
12652 @item show debug monitor
12653 @kindex show debug monitor
12654 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12655 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12656 @end table
12657
12658 @table @code
12659
12660 @kindex load @var{filename}
12661 @item load @var{filename}
12662 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12663 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12664 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12665 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12666 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12667 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12668
12669 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12670 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12671 target is @dots{}}''
12672
12673 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12674 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12675 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12676 specifies a fixed address.
12677 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12678
12679 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12680 load programs into flash memory.
12681
12682 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12683 @end table
12684
12685 @node Byte Order
12686 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12687
12688 @cindex choosing target byte order
12689 @cindex target byte order
12690
12691 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12692 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12693 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12694 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12695 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12696 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12697
12698 @table @code
12699 @kindex set endian
12700 @item set endian big
12701 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12702
12703 @item set endian little
12704 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12705
12706 @item set endian auto
12707 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12708 executable.
12709
12710 @item show endian
12711 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12712
12713 @end table
12714
12715 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12716 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12717 target system.
12718
12719
12720 @node Remote Debugging
12721 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12722 @cindex remote debugging
12723
12724 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12725 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12726 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12727 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12728 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12729
12730 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12731 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12732 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12733 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12734 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12735 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12736
12737 Other remote targets may be available in your
12738 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12739
12740 @menu
12741 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12742 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12743 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12744 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12745 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12746 @end menu
12747
12748 @node Connecting
12749 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12750
12751 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12752 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12753 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12754 program as the first argument.
12755
12756 @cindex @code{target remote}
12757 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12758 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12759 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12760 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12761 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12762 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12763
12764 @table @code
12765
12766 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12767 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12768 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12769 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12770
12771 @smallexample
12772 target remote /dev/ttyb
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12776 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12777 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12778 @code{target} command.
12779
12780 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12781 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12782 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12783 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12784 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12785 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12786 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12787 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12788 target.
12789
12790 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12791 @code{manyfarms}:
12792
12793 @smallexample
12794 target remote manyfarms:2828
12795 @end smallexample
12796
12797 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12798 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12799 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12800 port 1234 on your local machine:
12801
12802 @smallexample
12803 target remote :1234
12804 @end smallexample
12805 @noindent
12806
12807 Note that the colon is still required here.
12808
12809 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12810 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12811 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12812 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12813
12814 @smallexample
12815 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12816 @end smallexample
12817
12818 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12819 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12820 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12821 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12822
12823 @item target remote | @var{command}
12824 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12825 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12826 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12827 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12828 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12829 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12830 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12831 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12832
12833 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12834 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12835 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12836
12837 @end table
12838
12839 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12840 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12841 remote program.
12842
12843 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12844 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12845 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12846 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12847 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12848 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12849 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12850
12851 @smallexample
12852 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12853 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12854 @end smallexample
12855
12856 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12857 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12858 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12859 goes back to waiting.
12860
12861 @table @code
12862 @kindex detach (remote)
12863 @item detach
12864 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12865 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12866 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12867 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12868 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12869
12870 @kindex disconnect
12871 @item disconnect
12872 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12873 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12874 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12875 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12876 another target.
12877
12878 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12879 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12880 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12881 @kindex monitor
12882 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12883 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12884 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12885 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12886 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12887 and implement.
12888 @end table
12889
12890 @node File Transfer
12891 @section Sending files to a remote system
12892 @cindex remote target, file transfer
12893 @cindex file transfer
12894 @cindex sending files to remote systems
12895
12896 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12897 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
12898 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
12899 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
12900 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
12901 the only way to upload or download files.
12902
12903 Not all remote targets support these commands.
12904
12905 @table @code
12906 @kindex remote put
12907 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
12908 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
12909 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
12910
12911 @kindex remote get
12912 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
12913 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
12914 on the host system.
12915
12916 @kindex remote delete
12917 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
12918 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
12919
12920 @end table
12921
12922 @node Server
12923 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12924
12925 @kindex gdbserver
12926 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12927 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12928 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12929 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12930
12931 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12932 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12933 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12934 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12935 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12936 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12937 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12938 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12939 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12940 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12941 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12942 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12943 choice for debugging.
12944
12945 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12946 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12947 protocol.
12948
12949 @table @emph
12950 @item On the target machine,
12951 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12952 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12953 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12954 system does all the symbol handling.
12955
12956 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12957 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12958 syntax is:
12959
12960 @smallexample
12961 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12962 @end smallexample
12963
12964 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12965 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12966 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12967 @file{/dev/com1}:
12968
12969 @smallexample
12970 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12971 @end smallexample
12972
12973 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12974 with it.
12975
12976 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12977
12978 @smallexample
12979 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12980 @end smallexample
12981
12982 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12983 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12984 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12985 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12986 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12987 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12988 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12989 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12990 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12991 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12992 @code{target remote} command.
12993
12994 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12995 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12996
12997 @smallexample
12998 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12999 @end smallexample
13000
13001 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13002 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13003
13004 @pindex pidof
13005 @cindex attach to a program by name
13006 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13007 @code{pidof} utility:
13008
13009 @smallexample
13010 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
13011 @end smallexample
13012
13013 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13014 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13015 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13016
13017 @item On the host machine,
13018 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13019 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13020 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13021 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
13022
13023 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13024 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13025 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13026 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13027 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13028 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13029 programs.
13030
13031 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13032 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13033 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13034 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13035 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
13036 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13037 already on the target.
13038
13039 @end table
13040
13041 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13042 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13043
13044 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13045 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13046 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
13047 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
13048
13049 @table @code
13050 @item monitor help
13051 List the available monitor commands.
13052
13053 @item monitor set debug 0
13054 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13055 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13056
13057 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13058 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13059 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13060 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13061
13062 @end table
13063
13064 @node Remote Configuration
13065 @section Remote Configuration
13066
13067 @kindex set remote
13068 @kindex show remote
13069 This section documents the configuration options available when
13070 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13071 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13072 system-call-allowed}.
13073
13074 @table @code
13075 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13076 @cindex address size for remote targets
13077 @cindex bits in remote address
13078 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13079 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13080 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13081 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13082
13083 @item show remoteaddresssize
13084 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13085
13086 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13087 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13088 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13089 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13090 remote targets.
13091
13092 @item show remotebaud
13093 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13094
13095 @item set remotebreak
13096 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13097 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13098 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13099 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13100 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13101 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13102 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13103 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13104
13105 @item show remotebreak
13106 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13107 interrupt the remote program.
13108
13109 @item set remoteflow on
13110 @itemx set remoteflow off
13111 @kindex set remoteflow
13112 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13113 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13114
13115 @item show remoteflow
13116 @kindex show remoteflow
13117 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13118
13119 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13120 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13121 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13122 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13123 @code{ascii}.
13124
13125 @item show remotelogbase
13126 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13127 protocol.
13128
13129 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13130 @cindex record serial communications on file
13131 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13132 default is not to record at all.
13133
13134 @item show remotelogfile.
13135 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13136 serial communications.
13137
13138 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13139 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13140 @cindex remote timeout
13141 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13142 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13143
13144 @item show remotetimeout
13145 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13146 responses.
13147
13148 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13149 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13150 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13151 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13152 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13153 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13154 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13155 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13156 @end table
13157
13158 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13159 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13160 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13161 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13162 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13163 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13164 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13165 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13166 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13167
13168 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13169 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13170 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13171 @value{GDBN} developers.
13172
13173 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13174 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13175 are:
13176
13177 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13178 @item Command Name
13179 @tab Remote Packet
13180 @tab Related Features
13181
13182 @item @code{fetch-register}
13183 @tab @code{p}
13184 @tab @code{info registers}
13185
13186 @item @code{set-register}
13187 @tab @code{P}
13188 @tab @code{set}
13189
13190 @item @code{binary-download}
13191 @tab @code{X}
13192 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13193
13194 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13195 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13196 @tab @code{info auxv}
13197
13198 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13199 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13200 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13201
13202 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13203 @tab @code{vCont}
13204 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13205
13206 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13207 @tab @code{Z0}
13208 @tab @code{break}
13209
13210 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13211 @tab @code{Z1}
13212 @tab @code{hbreak}
13213
13214 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13215 @tab @code{Z2}
13216 @tab @code{watch}
13217
13218 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13219 @tab @code{Z3}
13220 @tab @code{rwatch}
13221
13222 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13223 @tab @code{Z4}
13224 @tab @code{awatch}
13225
13226 @item @code{target-features}
13227 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13228 @tab @code{set architecture}
13229
13230 @item @code{library-info}
13231 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13232 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13233
13234 @item @code{memory-map}
13235 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13236 @tab @code{info mem}
13237
13238 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13239 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13240 @tab @code{info spu}
13241
13242 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13243 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13244 @tab @code{info spu}
13245
13246 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13247 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13248 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13249
13250 @item @code{supported-packets}
13251 @tab @code{qSupported}
13252 @tab Remote communications parameters
13253
13254 @item @code{pass-signals}
13255 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13256 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13257
13258 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13259 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13260 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13261
13262 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13263 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13264 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13265
13266 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13267 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13268 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13269
13270 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13271 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13272 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13273
13274 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13275 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13276 @tab @code{remote delete}
13277 @end multitable
13278
13279 @node Remote Stub
13280 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13281
13282 @cindex debugging stub, example
13283 @cindex remote stub, example
13284 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13285 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13286 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13287 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13288 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13289 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13290 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13291 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13292
13293 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13294 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13295 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13296 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13297 program, you need:
13298
13299 @enumerate
13300 @item
13301 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13302 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13303 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13304
13305 @item
13306 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13307 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13308
13309 @item
13310 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13311 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13312 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13313 documentation.
13314 @end enumerate
13315
13316 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13317 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13318 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13319
13320 @table @emph
13321 @item On the host,
13322 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13323 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13324 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13325
13326 @item On the target,
13327 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13328 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13329 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13330
13331 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13332 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13333 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13334 @end table
13335
13336 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13337 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13338 @sc{sparc} boards.
13339
13340 @cindex remote serial stub list
13341 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13342
13343 @table @code
13344
13345 @item i386-stub.c
13346 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13347 @cindex Intel
13348 @cindex i386
13349 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13350
13351 @item m68k-stub.c
13352 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13353 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13354 @cindex m680x0
13355 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13356
13357 @item sh-stub.c
13358 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13359 @cindex Renesas
13360 @cindex SH
13361 For Renesas SH architectures.
13362
13363 @item sparc-stub.c
13364 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13365 @cindex Sparc
13366 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13367
13368 @item sparcl-stub.c
13369 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13370 @cindex Fujitsu
13371 @cindex SparcLite
13372 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13373
13374 @end table
13375
13376 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13377 recently added stubs.
13378
13379 @menu
13380 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13381 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13382 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13383 @end menu
13384
13385 @node Stub Contents
13386 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13387
13388 @cindex remote serial stub
13389 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13390 subroutines:
13391
13392 @table @code
13393 @item set_debug_traps
13394 @findex set_debug_traps
13395 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13396 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13397 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13398 beginning of your program.
13399
13400 @item handle_exception
13401 @findex handle_exception
13402 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13403 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13404 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13405 run when a trap is triggered.
13406
13407 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13408 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13409 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13410 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13411 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13412 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13413 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13414 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13415 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13416 machine.
13417
13418 @item breakpoint
13419 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13420 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13421 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13422 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13423 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13424 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13425 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13426 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13427 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13428 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13429 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13430
13431 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13432 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13433 start of your debugging session.
13434 @end table
13435
13436 @node Bootstrapping
13437 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13438
13439 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13440 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13441 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13442 debugging target machine.
13443
13444 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13445 serial port.
13446
13447 @table @code
13448 @item int getDebugChar()
13449 @findex getDebugChar
13450 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13451 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13452 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13453
13454 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13455 @findex putDebugChar
13456 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13457 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13458 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13459 @end table
13460
13461 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13462 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13463 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13464 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13465 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13466 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13467 remote system to stop.
13468
13469 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13470 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13471 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13472 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13473
13474 Other routines you need to supply are:
13475
13476 @table @code
13477 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13478 @findex exceptionHandler
13479 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13480 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13481 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13482 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13483 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13484 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13485 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13486 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13487 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13488 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13489 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13490 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13491 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13492
13493 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13494 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13495 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13496 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13497 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13498
13499 @item void flush_i_cache()
13500 @findex flush_i_cache
13501 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13502 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13503 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13504
13505 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13506 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13507 @end table
13508
13509 @noindent
13510 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13511
13512 @table @code
13513 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13514 @findex memset
13515 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13516 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13517 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13518 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13519 @end table
13520
13521 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13522 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13523 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13524 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13525
13526
13527 @node Debug Session
13528 @subsection Putting it All Together
13529
13530 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13531 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13532 steps.
13533
13534 @enumerate
13535 @item
13536 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13537 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13538 @display
13539 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13540 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13541 @end display
13542
13543 @item
13544 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13545
13546 @smallexample
13547 set_debug_traps();
13548 breakpoint();
13549 @end smallexample
13550
13551 @item
13552 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13553 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13554
13555 @smallexample
13556 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13557 @end smallexample
13558
13559 @noindent
13560 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13561 function in your program, that function is called when
13562 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13563 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13564 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13565
13566 @item
13567 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13568 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13569
13570 @item
13571 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13572 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13573
13574 @item
13575 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13576 @c document that. FIXME.
13577 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13578 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13579
13580 @item
13581 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13582 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13583
13584 @end enumerate
13585
13586 @node Configurations
13587 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13588
13589 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13590 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13591 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13592
13593 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13594 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13595 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13596 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13597 are quite different from each other.
13598
13599 @menu
13600 * Native::
13601 * Embedded OS::
13602 * Embedded Processors::
13603 * Architectures::
13604 @end menu
13605
13606 @node Native
13607 @section Native
13608
13609 This section describes details specific to particular native
13610 configurations.
13611
13612 @menu
13613 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13614 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13615 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13616 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13617 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13618 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13619 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13620 @end menu
13621
13622 @node HP-UX
13623 @subsection HP-UX
13624
13625 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13626 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13627 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13628
13629
13630 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13631 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13632
13633 @cindex libkvm
13634 @cindex kernel memory image
13635 @cindex kernel crash dump
13636
13637 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13638 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13639 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13640 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13641 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13642 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13643 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13644 @code{kvm} target:
13645
13646 @smallexample
13647 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13648 @end smallexample
13649
13650 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13651 argument:
13652
13653 @smallexample
13654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13655 @end smallexample
13656
13657 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13658 available:
13659
13660 @table @code
13661 @kindex kvm
13662 @item kvm pcb
13663 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13664
13665 @item kvm proc
13666 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13667 modern FreeBSD systems.
13668 @end table
13669
13670 @node SVR4 Process Information
13671 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13672 @cindex /proc
13673 @cindex examine process image
13674 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13675
13676 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13677 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13678 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13679 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13680 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13681 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13682 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13683 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13684 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13685
13686 @table @code
13687 @kindex info proc
13688 @cindex process ID
13689 @item info proc
13690 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13691 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13692 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13693 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13694 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13695 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13696 executable file's absolute file name.
13697
13698 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13699 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13700 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13701 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13702 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13703 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13704
13705 @item info proc mappings
13706 @cindex memory address space mappings
13707 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13708 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13709 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13710 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13711 memory access rights to that range.
13712
13713 @item info proc stat
13714 @itemx info proc status
13715 @cindex process detailed status information
13716 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13717 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13718 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13719 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13720 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13721 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13722 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13723
13724 @item info proc all
13725 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13726 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13727
13728 @ignore
13729 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13730 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13731 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13732 @kindex info proc times
13733 @item info proc times
13734 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13735 its children.
13736
13737 @kindex info proc id
13738 @item info proc id
13739 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13740 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13741 @end ignore
13742
13743 @item set procfs-trace
13744 @kindex set procfs-trace
13745 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13746 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13747
13748 @item show procfs-trace
13749 @kindex show procfs-trace
13750 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13751
13752 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13753 @kindex set procfs-file
13754 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13755 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13756 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13757 standard output.
13758
13759 @item show procfs-file
13760 @kindex show procfs-file
13761 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13762
13763 @item proc-trace-entry
13764 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13765 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13766 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13767 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13768 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13769 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13770 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13771 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13772 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13773
13774 @item info pidlist
13775 @kindex info pidlist
13776 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13777 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13778 processes and all the threads within each process.
13779
13780 @item info meminfo
13781 @kindex info meminfo
13782 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13783 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13784 @end table
13785
13786 @node DJGPP Native
13787 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13788 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13789 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13790 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13791
13792 @cindex DPMI
13793 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13794 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13795 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13796 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13797
13798 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13799 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13800 subsection describes those commands.
13801
13802 @table @code
13803 @kindex info dos
13804 @item info dos
13805 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13806 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13807
13808 @kindex sysinfo
13809 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13810 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13811 @item info dos sysinfo
13812 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13813 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13814 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13815
13816 @cindex GDT
13817 @cindex LDT
13818 @cindex IDT
13819 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13820 @cindex descriptor tables display
13821 @item info dos gdt
13822 @itemx info dos ldt
13823 @itemx info dos idt
13824 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13825 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13826 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13827 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13828 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13829 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13830 rights.
13831
13832 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13833 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13834 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13835 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13836 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13837
13838 @cindex garbled pointers
13839 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13840 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13841 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13842 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13843 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13844 debugged program's data segment:
13845
13846 @smallexample
13847 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13848 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13849 @end smallexample
13850
13851 @noindent
13852 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13853 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13854
13855 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13856 @item info dos pde
13857 @itemx info dos pte
13858 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13859 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13860 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13861 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13862 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13863 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13864 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13865 that is currently in use.
13866
13867 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13868 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13869 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13870 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13871 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13872 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13873 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13874
13875 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13876 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13877 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13878 controller.
13879
13880 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13881
13882 @cindex physical address from linear address
13883 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13884 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13885 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13886 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13887 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13888 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13889 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13890
13891 @smallexample
13892 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13893 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13894 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13895 @end smallexample
13896
13897 @noindent
13898 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13899 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13900 attributes of that page.
13901
13902 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13903 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13904 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13905 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13906 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13907 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13908
13909 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13910 transfer buffer:
13911
13912 @smallexample
13913 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13914 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13915 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13916 @end smallexample
13917
13918 @noindent
13919 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13920 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13921 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13922 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13923 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13924
13925 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13926 @end table
13927
13928 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13929 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13930 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13931 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13932
13933 @table @code
13934 @kindex set com1base
13935 @kindex set com1irq
13936 @kindex set com2base
13937 @kindex set com2irq
13938 @kindex set com3base
13939 @kindex set com3irq
13940 @kindex set com4base
13941 @kindex set com4irq
13942 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13943 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13944 port.
13945
13946 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13947 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13948 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13949
13950 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13951 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13952 other 3 COM ports.
13953
13954 @kindex show com1base
13955 @kindex show com1irq
13956 @kindex show com2base
13957 @kindex show com2irq
13958 @kindex show com3base
13959 @kindex show com3irq
13960 @kindex show com4base
13961 @kindex show com4irq
13962 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13963 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13964 lines used by the COM ports.
13965
13966 @item info serial
13967 @kindex info serial
13968 @cindex DOS serial port status
13969 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13970 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13971 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13972 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13973 @end table
13974
13975
13976 @node Cygwin Native
13977 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13978 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13979 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13980 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13981
13982 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13983 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13984 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13985 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13986 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13987
13988 @table @code
13989 @kindex info w32
13990 @item info w32
13991 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13992 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13993
13994 @item info w32 selector
13995 This command displays information returned by
13996 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13997 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13998 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13999 Without argument, this command displays information
14000 about the six segment registers.
14001
14002 @kindex info dll
14003 @item info dll
14004 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14005
14006 @kindex dll-symbols
14007 @item dll-symbols
14008 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14009 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14010
14011 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14012 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14013 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14014 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14015 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14016 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14017 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14018 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14019 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14020 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14021 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14022
14023 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14024 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14025 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14026 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14027
14028 @kindex set new-console
14029 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14030 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14031 be started in a new console on next start.
14032 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14033 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14034
14035 @kindex show new-console
14036 @item show new-console
14037 Displays whether a new console is used
14038 when the debuggee is started.
14039
14040 @kindex set new-group
14041 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14042 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14043 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14044 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14045 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14046
14047 @kindex show new-group
14048 @item show new-group
14049 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14050
14051 @kindex set debugevents
14052 @item set debugevents
14053 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14054 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14055 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14056 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14057 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14058
14059 @kindex set debugexec
14060 @item set debugexec
14061 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14062 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14063
14064 @kindex set debugexceptions
14065 @item set debugexceptions
14066 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14067 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14068
14069 @kindex set debugmemory
14070 @item set debugmemory
14071 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14072 and writes by the debugger.
14073
14074 @kindex set shell
14075 @item set shell
14076 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14077 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14078
14079 @kindex show shell
14080 @item show shell
14081 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14082
14083 @end table
14084
14085 @menu
14086 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14087 @end menu
14088
14089 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14090 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14091 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14092 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14093
14094 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14095 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14096 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14097 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14098 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14099 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14100 ``minimal symbols''.
14101
14102 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14103 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14104 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14105 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14106 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14107 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14108 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14109 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14110 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14111 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14112
14113 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14114
14115 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14116 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14117 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14118 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14119 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14120 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14121 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14122 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14123 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14124
14125 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14126 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14127 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14128 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14129 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14130 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14131
14132 @smallexample
14133 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14134 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14135
14136 Non-debugging symbols:
14137 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14138 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14139 @end smallexample
14140
14141 @smallexample
14142 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14143 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14144
14145 Non-debugging symbols:
14146 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14147 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14148 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14149 [etc...]
14150 @end smallexample
14151
14152 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14153
14154 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14155 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14156 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14157 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14158 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14159 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14160 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14161
14162 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14163 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14164 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14165 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14166 problem:
14167
14168 @smallexample
14169 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14170 $1 = 268572168
14171 @end smallexample
14172
14173 @smallexample
14174 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14175 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14176 @end smallexample
14177
14178 And two possible solutions:
14179
14180 @smallexample
14181 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14182 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14183 @end smallexample
14184
14185 @smallexample
14186 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14187 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14188 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14189 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14190 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14191 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14192 @end smallexample
14193
14194 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14195 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14196 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14197 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14198 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14199
14200 @smallexample
14201 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14202 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14203 @end smallexample
14204
14205 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14206 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14207 safe.
14208
14209 @node Hurd Native
14210 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14211 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14212
14213 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14214 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14215
14216 @table @code
14217 @item set signals
14218 @itemx set sigs
14219 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14220 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14221 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14222 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14223 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14224 @code{signals}.
14225
14226 @item show signals
14227 @itemx show sigs
14228 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14229 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14230 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14231
14232 @item set signal-thread
14233 @itemx set sigthread
14234 @kindex set signal-thread
14235 @kindex set sigthread
14236 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14237 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14238 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14239 signal-thread}.
14240
14241 @item show signal-thread
14242 @itemx show sigthread
14243 @kindex show signal-thread
14244 @kindex show sigthread
14245 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14246 delivered a signal.
14247
14248 @item set stopped
14249 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14250 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14251 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14252 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14253
14254 @item show stopped
14255 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14256 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14257 stopped.
14258
14259 @item set exceptions
14260 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14261 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14262 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14263 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14264 trapping on.
14265
14266 @item show exceptions
14267 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14268 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14269
14270 @item set task pause
14271 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14272 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14273 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14274 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14275 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14276 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14277 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14278 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14279 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14280
14281 @item show task pause
14282 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14283 Show the current state of task suspension.
14284
14285 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14286 @cindex task suspend count
14287 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14288 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14289 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14290
14291 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14292 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14293
14294 @item set task exception-port
14295 @itemx set task excp
14296 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14297 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14298 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14299 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14300
14301 @item set noninvasive
14302 @cindex noninvasive task options
14303 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14304 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14305 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14306 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14307
14308 @item info send-rights
14309 @itemx info receive-rights
14310 @itemx info port-rights
14311 @itemx info port-sets
14312 @itemx info dead-names
14313 @itemx info ports
14314 @itemx info psets
14315 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14316 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14317 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14318 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14319 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14320 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14321 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14322 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14323 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14324
14325 @item set thread pause
14326 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14327 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14328 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14329 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14330 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14331 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14332 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14333 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14334 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14335 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14336 only the current thread.
14337
14338 @item show thread pause
14339 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14340 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14341
14342 @item set thread run
14343 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14344
14345 @item show thread run
14346 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14347
14348 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14349 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14350 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14351 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14352 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14353 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14354 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14355
14356 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14357 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14358 detaching.
14359
14360 @item set thread exception-port
14361 @itemx set thread excp
14362 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14363 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14364 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14365
14366 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14367 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14368 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14369 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14370
14371 @item set thread default
14372 @itemx show thread default
14373 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14374 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14375 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14376 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14377 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14378 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14379 the non-default commands.
14380 @end table
14381
14382
14383 @node Neutrino
14384 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14385 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14386
14387 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14388 Neutrino target:
14389
14390 @table @code
14391 @item set debug nto-debug
14392 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14393 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14394 Neutrino support.
14395
14396 @item show debug nto-debug
14397 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14398 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14399 @end table
14400
14401
14402 @node Embedded OS
14403 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14404
14405 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14406 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14407 architectures.
14408
14409 @menu
14410 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14411 @end menu
14412
14413 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14414 various real-time operating systems.
14415
14416 @node VxWorks
14417 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14418
14419 @cindex VxWorks
14420
14421 @table @code
14422
14423 @kindex target vxworks
14424 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14425 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14426 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14427
14428 @end table
14429
14430 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14431 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14432
14433 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14434 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14435 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14436 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14437 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14438 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14439 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14440
14441 @table @code
14442 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14443 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14444 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14445 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14446 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14447 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14448 of a thin network line.
14449 @end table
14450
14451 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14452 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14453 procedures.
14454
14455 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14456 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14457 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14458 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14459 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14460 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14461 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14462 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14463 manual.
14464 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14465
14466 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14467 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14468 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14469 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14470
14471 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14472
14473 @smallexample
14474 (vxgdb)
14475 @end smallexample
14476
14477 @menu
14478 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14479 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14480 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14481 @end menu
14482
14483 @node VxWorks Connection
14484 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14485
14486 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14487 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14488
14489 @smallexample
14490 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14491 @end smallexample
14492
14493 @need 750
14494 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14495
14496 @smallexample
14497 Attaching remote machine across net...
14498 Connected to tt.
14499 @end smallexample
14500
14501 @need 1000
14502 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14503 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14504 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14505 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14506 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14507
14508 @smallexample
14509 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14510 @end smallexample
14511
14512 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14513 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14514 command again.
14515
14516 @node VxWorks Download
14517 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14518
14519 @cindex download to VxWorks
14520 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14521 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14522 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14523 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14524 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14525 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14526 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14527 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14528 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14529 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14530 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14531 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14532 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14533 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14534 program, type this on VxWorks:
14535
14536 @smallexample
14537 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14538 @end smallexample
14539
14540 @noindent
14541 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14542
14543 @smallexample
14544 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14545 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14546 @end smallexample
14547
14548 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14549
14550 @smallexample
14551 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14552 @end smallexample
14553
14554 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14555 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14556 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14557 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14558 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14559 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14560 table.)
14561
14562 @node VxWorks Attach
14563 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14564
14565 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14566 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14567 follows:
14568
14569 @smallexample
14570 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14571 @end smallexample
14572
14573 @noindent
14574 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14575 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14576 the time of attachment.
14577
14578 @node Embedded Processors
14579 @section Embedded Processors
14580
14581 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14582 configurations.
14583
14584 @cindex send command to simulator
14585 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14586 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14587
14588 @table @code
14589 @item sim @var{command}
14590 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14591 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14592 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14593 acceptable commands.
14594 @end table
14595
14596
14597 @menu
14598 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14599 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14600 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14601 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14602 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14603 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14604 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14605 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14606 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14607 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14608 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14609 * CRIS:: CRIS
14610 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14611 @end menu
14612
14613 @node ARM
14614 @subsection ARM
14615 @cindex ARM RDI
14616
14617 @table @code
14618 @kindex target rdi
14619 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14620 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14621 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14622 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14623
14624 @kindex target rdp
14625 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14626 ARM Demon monitor.
14627
14628 @end table
14629
14630 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14631
14632 @table @code
14633 @item set arm disassembler
14634 @kindex set arm
14635 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14636 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14637
14638 @item show arm disassembler
14639 @kindex show arm
14640 Show the current disassembly style.
14641
14642 @item set arm apcs32
14643 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14644 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14645
14646 @item show arm apcs32
14647 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14648
14649 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14650 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14651 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14652
14653 @table @code
14654 @item auto
14655 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14656 @item softfpa
14657 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14658 processors.
14659 @item fpa
14660 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14661 @item softvfp
14662 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14663 @item vfp
14664 VFP co-processor.
14665 @end table
14666
14667 @item show arm fpu
14668 Show the current type of the FPU.
14669
14670 @item set arm abi
14671 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14672
14673 @item show arm abi
14674 Show the currently used ABI.
14675
14676 @item set debug arm
14677 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14678 target support subsystem.
14679
14680 @item show debug arm
14681 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14682 @end table
14683
14684 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14685 using the RDI interface:
14686
14687 @table @code
14688 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14689 @kindex rdilogfile
14690 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14691 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14692 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14693 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14694 @file{rdi.log}.
14695
14696 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14697 @kindex rdilogenable
14698 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14699 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14700 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14701 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14702 are logged to a file.
14703
14704 @item set rdiromatzero
14705 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14706 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14707 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14708 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14709 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14710 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14711
14712 @item show rdiromatzero
14713 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14714 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14715
14716 @item set rdiheartbeat
14717 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14718 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14719 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14720 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14721 well as the Angel monitor.
14722
14723 @item show rdiheartbeat
14724 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14725 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14726 @end table
14727
14728
14729 @node M32R/D
14730 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14731
14732 @table @code
14733 @kindex target m32r
14734 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14735 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14736
14737 @kindex target m32rsdi
14738 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14739 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14740 @end table
14741
14742 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14743
14744 @table @code
14745 @item set download-path @var{path}
14746 @kindex set download-path
14747 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14748 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14749
14750 @item show download-path
14751 @kindex show download-path
14752 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14753
14754 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14755 @kindex set board-address
14756 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14757 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14758
14759 @item show board-address
14760 @kindex show board-address
14761 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14762
14763 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14764 @kindex set server-address
14765 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14766 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14767 host machine.
14768
14769 @item show server-address
14770 @kindex show server-address
14771 Display the IP address of the download server.
14772
14773 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14774 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14775 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14776 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14777 executable file is uploaded.
14778
14779 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14780 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14781 Test the @code{upload} command.
14782 @end table
14783
14784 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14785
14786 @table @code
14787 @item sdireset
14788 @kindex sdireset
14789 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14790 This command resets the SDI connection.
14791
14792 @item sdistatus
14793 @kindex sdistatus
14794 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14795
14796 @item debug_chaos
14797 @kindex debug_chaos
14798 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14799 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14800
14801 @item use_debug_dma
14802 @kindex use_debug_dma
14803 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14804
14805 @item use_mon_code
14806 @kindex use_mon_code
14807 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14808
14809 @item use_ib_break
14810 @kindex use_ib_break
14811 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14812
14813 @item use_dbt_break
14814 @kindex use_dbt_break
14815 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14816 @end table
14817
14818 @node M68K
14819 @subsection M68k
14820
14821 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14822 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14823
14824 @table @code
14825
14826 @kindex target dbug
14827 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14828 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14829
14830 @end table
14831
14832 @node MIPS Embedded
14833 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14834
14835 @cindex MIPS boards
14836 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14837 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14838 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14839
14840 @need 1000
14841 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14842
14843 @table @code
14844 @item target mips @var{port}
14845 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14846 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14847 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14848 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14849 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14850 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14851 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14852
14853 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14854 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14855 debugger:
14856
14857 @smallexample
14858 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14859 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14860 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14861 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14862 (@value{GDBP}) run
14863 @end smallexample
14864
14865 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14866 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14867 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14868 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14869 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14870
14871 @item target pmon @var{port}
14872 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14873 PMON ROM monitor.
14874
14875 @item target ddb @var{port}
14876 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14877 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14878
14879 @item target lsi @var{port}
14880 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14881 LSI variant of PMON.
14882
14883 @kindex target r3900
14884 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14885 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14886
14887 @kindex target array
14888 @item target array @var{dev}
14889 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14890
14891 @end table
14892
14893
14894 @noindent
14895 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14896
14897 @table @code
14898 @item set mipsfpu double
14899 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14900 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14901 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14902 @itemx show mipsfpu
14903 @kindex set mipsfpu
14904 @kindex show mipsfpu
14905 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14906 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14907 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14908 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14909 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14910 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14911 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14912 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14913 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14914 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14915 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14916 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14917 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14918
14919 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14920 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14921 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14922
14923 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14924 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14925
14926 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14927 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14928 @itemx show timeout
14929 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14930 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14931 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14932 @kindex set timeout
14933 @kindex show timeout
14934 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14935 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14936 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14937 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14938 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14939 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14940 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14941 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14942 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14943 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14944
14945 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14946 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14947 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14948 to run before stopping.
14949
14950 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14951 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14952 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14953 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14954 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14955 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14956
14957 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14958 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14959 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14960 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14961
14962 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14963 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14964 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14965 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14966 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14967 @table @asis
14968 @item pmon target
14969 @samp{PMON}
14970 @item ddb target
14971 @samp{NEC010}
14972 @item lsi target
14973 @samp{PMON>}
14974 @end table
14975
14976 @item show monitor-prompt
14977 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14978 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14979 remote monitor.
14980
14981 @item set monitor-warnings
14982 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14983 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14984 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14985 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14986 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14987
14988 @item show monitor-warnings
14989 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14990 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14991
14992 @item pmon @var{command}
14993 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14994 @cindex send PMON command
14995 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14996 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14997 @end table
14998
14999 @node OpenRISC 1000
15000 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15001 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15002
15003 @cindex or1k boards
15004 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15005 about platform and commands.
15006
15007 @table @code
15008
15009 @kindex target jtag
15010 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15011
15012 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15013 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15014 connected via parallel port to the board.
15015
15016 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15017
15018 @kindex or1ksim
15019 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15020 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15021 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15022
15023 @kindex info or1k spr
15024 @item info or1k spr
15025 Displays spr groups.
15026
15027 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15028 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15029 Displays register names in selected group.
15030
15031 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15032 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15033 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15034 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15035 Shows information about specified spr register.
15036
15037 @kindex spr
15038 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15039 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15040 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15041 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15042 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15043 @end table
15044
15045 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15046 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15047 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15048 triggers can be set using:
15049 @table @code
15050 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15051 Load effective address/data
15052 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15053 Store effective address/data
15054 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15055 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15056 @item $FETCH
15057 Fetch data
15058 @end table
15059
15060 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15061 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15062
15063 @code{htrace} commands:
15064 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15065 @table @code
15066 @kindex hwatch
15067 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15068 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15069 or Data. For example:
15070
15071 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15072
15073 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15074
15075 @kindex htrace
15076 @item htrace info
15077 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15078
15079 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15080 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15081
15082 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15083 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15084
15085 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15086 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15087
15088 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15089 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15090 triggered.
15091
15092 @item htrace enable
15093 @itemx htrace disable
15094 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15095
15096 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15097 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15098
15099 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15100 will be written there.
15101
15102 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15103 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15104
15105 @item htrace mode continuous
15106 Set continuous trace mode.
15107
15108 @item htrace mode suspend
15109 Set suspend trace mode.
15110
15111 @end table
15112
15113 @node PowerPC
15114 @subsection PowerPC
15115
15116 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15117
15118 @table @code
15119 @kindex set powerpc
15120 @item set powerpc soft-float
15121 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15122 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15123 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15124 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15125
15126 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15127 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15128 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15129 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15130 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15131 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15132 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15133 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15134
15135 @kindex target dink32
15136 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15137 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15138
15139 @kindex target ppcbug
15140 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15141 @kindex target ppcbug1
15142 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15143 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15144
15145 @kindex target sds
15146 @item target sds @var{dev}
15147 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15148 @end table
15149
15150 @cindex SDS protocol
15151 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15152 by @value{GDBN}:
15153
15154 @table @code
15155 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15156 @kindex set sdstimeout
15157 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15158 default is 2 seconds.
15159
15160 @item show sdstimeout
15161 @kindex show sdstimeout
15162 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15163
15164 @item sds @var{command}
15165 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15166 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15167 @end table
15168
15169
15170 @node PA
15171 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15172
15173 @table @code
15174
15175 @kindex target op50n
15176 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15177 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15178
15179 @kindex target w89k
15180 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15181 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15182
15183 @end table
15184
15185 @node Sparclet
15186 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15187
15188 @cindex Sparclet
15189
15190 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15191 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15192 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15193 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15194 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15195
15196 @table @code
15197 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15198 @kindex remotetimeout
15199 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15200 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15201 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15202 @end table
15203
15204 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15205 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15206 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15207 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15208 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15209
15210 @smallexample
15211 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15212 @end smallexample
15213
15214 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15215
15216 @smallexample
15217 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15218 @end smallexample
15219
15220 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15221 Once you have set
15222 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15223 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15224 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15225
15226 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15227
15228 @smallexample
15229 (gdbslet)
15230 @end smallexample
15231
15232 @menu
15233 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15234 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15235 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15236 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15237 @end menu
15238
15239 @node Sparclet File
15240 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15241
15242 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15243
15244 @smallexample
15245 (gdbslet) file prog
15246 @end smallexample
15247
15248 @need 1000
15249 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15250 @value{GDBN} locates
15251 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15252 path.
15253 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15254 files will be searched as well.
15255 @value{GDBN} locates
15256 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15257 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15258 If it fails
15259 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15260
15261 @smallexample
15262 prog: No such file or directory.
15263 @end smallexample
15264
15265 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15266 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15267 @code{target} command again.
15268
15269 @node Sparclet Connection
15270 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15271
15272 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15273 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15274
15275 @smallexample
15276 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15277 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15278 main () at ../prog.c:3
15279 @end smallexample
15280
15281 @need 750
15282 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15283
15284 @smallexample
15285 Connected to ttya.
15286 @end smallexample
15287
15288 @node Sparclet Download
15289 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15290
15291 @cindex download to Sparclet
15292 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15293 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15294 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15295 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15296 command.
15297 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15298 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15299 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15300 of each of the file's sections.
15301 For instance, if the program
15302 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15303 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15304
15305 @smallexample
15306 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15307 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15308 @end smallexample
15309
15310 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15311 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15312 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15313
15314 @node Sparclet Execution
15315 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15316
15317 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15318 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15319 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15320 manual for the list of commands.
15321
15322 @smallexample
15323 (gdbslet) b main
15324 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15325 (gdbslet) run
15326 Starting program: prog
15327 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15328 3 char *symarg = 0;
15329 (gdbslet) step
15330 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15331 (gdbslet)
15332 @end smallexample
15333
15334 @node Sparclite
15335 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15336
15337 @table @code
15338
15339 @kindex target sparclite
15340 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15341 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15342 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15343 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15344 remote protocol.
15345
15346 @end table
15347
15348 @node Z8000
15349 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15350
15351 @cindex Z8000
15352 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15353 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15354
15355 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15356 a Z8000 simulator.
15357
15358 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15359 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15360 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15361 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15362
15363 @table @code
15364 @item target sim @var{args}
15365 @kindex sim
15366 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15367 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15368 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15369 @end table
15370
15371 @noindent
15372 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15373 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15374 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15375 to run your program, and so on.
15376
15377 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15378 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15379 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15380
15381 @table @code
15382
15383 @item cycles
15384 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15385
15386 @item insts
15387 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15388
15389 @item time
15390 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15391
15392 @end table
15393
15394 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15395 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15396 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15397 simulated clock ticks.
15398
15399 @node AVR
15400 @subsection Atmel AVR
15401 @cindex AVR
15402
15403 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15404 following AVR-specific commands:
15405
15406 @table @code
15407 @item info io_registers
15408 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15409 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15410 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15411 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15412 @end table
15413
15414 @node CRIS
15415 @subsection CRIS
15416 @cindex CRIS
15417
15418 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15419 following CRIS-specific commands:
15420
15421 @table @code
15422 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15423 @cindex CRIS version
15424 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15425 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15426 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15427
15428 @item show cris-version
15429 Show the current CRIS version.
15430
15431 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15432 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15433 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15434 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15435 @code{R59}.
15436
15437 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15438 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15439
15440 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15441 @cindex CRIS mode
15442 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15443 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15444 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15445
15446 @item show cris-mode
15447 Show the current CRIS mode.
15448 @end table
15449
15450 @node Super-H
15451 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15452 @cindex Super-H
15453
15454 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15455 commands:
15456
15457 @table @code
15458 @item regs
15459 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15460 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15461 @end table
15462
15463
15464 @node Architectures
15465 @section Architectures
15466
15467 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15468 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15469
15470 @menu
15471 * i386::
15472 * A29K::
15473 * Alpha::
15474 * MIPS::
15475 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15476 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15477 @end menu
15478
15479 @node i386
15480 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15481
15482 @table @code
15483 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15484 @kindex set struct-convention
15485 @cindex struct return convention
15486 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15487 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15488 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15489 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15490 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15491 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15492 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15493 be returned in a register.
15494
15495 @item show struct-convention
15496 @kindex show struct-convention
15497 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15498 from functions.
15499 @end table
15500
15501 @node A29K
15502 @subsection A29K
15503
15504 @table @code
15505
15506 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15507 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15508 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15509 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15510 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15511 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15512 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15513 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15514 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15515 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15516 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15517 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15518 hexadecimal.
15519
15520 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15521 @item show rstack_high_address
15522 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15523 processors.
15524
15525 @end table
15526
15527 @node Alpha
15528 @subsection Alpha
15529
15530 See the following section.
15531
15532 @node MIPS
15533 @subsection MIPS
15534
15535 @cindex stack on Alpha
15536 @cindex stack on MIPS
15537 @cindex Alpha stack
15538 @cindex MIPS stack
15539 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15540 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15541 find the beginning of a function.
15542
15543 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15544 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15545 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15546 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15547 commands:
15548
15549 @table @code
15550 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15551 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15552 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15553 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15554 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15555 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15556 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15557 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15558
15559 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15560 Display the current limit.
15561 @end table
15562
15563 @noindent
15564 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15565 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15566
15567 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15568 programs:
15569
15570 @table @code
15571 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15572 @kindex set mips abi
15573 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15574 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15575 values of @var{arg} are:
15576
15577 @table @samp
15578 @item auto
15579 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15580 default).
15581 @item o32
15582 @item o64
15583 @item n32
15584 @item n64
15585 @item eabi32
15586 @item eabi64
15587 @item auto
15588 @end table
15589
15590 @item show mips abi
15591 @kindex show mips abi
15592 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15593
15594 @item set mipsfpu
15595 @itemx show mipsfpu
15596 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15597
15598 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15599 @kindex set mips mask-address
15600 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15601 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15602 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15603 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15604 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15605
15606 @item show mips mask-address
15607 @kindex show mips mask-address
15608 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15609 not.
15610
15611 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15612 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15613 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15614 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15615 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15616 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15617
15618 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15619 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15620 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15621
15622 @item set debug mips
15623 @kindex set debug mips
15624 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15625 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15626
15627 @item show debug mips
15628 @kindex show debug mips
15629 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15630 @end table
15631
15632
15633 @node HPPA
15634 @subsection HPPA
15635 @cindex HPPA support
15636
15637 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15638 following special commands:
15639
15640 @table @code
15641 @item set debug hppa
15642 @kindex set debug hppa
15643 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15644 messages are to be displayed.
15645
15646 @item show debug hppa
15647 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15648
15649 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15650 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15651 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15652 given @var{address}.
15653
15654 @end table
15655
15656
15657 @node SPU
15658 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15659 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15660 @cindex SPU
15661
15662 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15663 it provides the following special commands:
15664
15665 @table @code
15666 @item info spu event
15667 @kindex info spu
15668 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15669 and pending event status.
15670
15671 @item info spu signal
15672 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15673 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15674 notification channels.
15675
15676 @item info spu mailbox
15677 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15678 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15679 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15680
15681 @item info spu dma
15682 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15683 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15684 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15685
15686 @item info spu proxydma
15687 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15688 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15689 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15690
15691 @end table
15692
15693
15694 @node Controlling GDB
15695 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15696
15697 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15698 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15699 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15700 described here.
15701
15702 @menu
15703 * Prompt:: Prompt
15704 * Editing:: Command editing
15705 * Command History:: Command history
15706 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15707 * Numbers:: Numbers
15708 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15709 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15710 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15711 @end menu
15712
15713 @node Prompt
15714 @section Prompt
15715
15716 @cindex prompt
15717
15718 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15719 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15720 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15721 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15722 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15723 which one you are talking to.
15724
15725 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15726 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15727 or a prompt that does not.
15728
15729 @table @code
15730 @kindex set prompt
15731 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15732 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15733
15734 @kindex show prompt
15735 @item show prompt
15736 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15737 @end table
15738
15739 @node Editing
15740 @section Command Editing
15741 @cindex readline
15742 @cindex command line editing
15743
15744 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15745 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15746 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15747 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15748 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15749 debugging sessions.
15750
15751 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15752 command @code{set}.
15753
15754 @table @code
15755 @kindex set editing
15756 @cindex editing
15757 @item set editing
15758 @itemx set editing on
15759 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15760
15761 @item set editing off
15762 Disable command line editing.
15763
15764 @kindex show editing
15765 @item show editing
15766 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15767 @end table
15768
15769 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15770 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15771 encouraged to read that chapter.
15772
15773 @node Command History
15774 @section Command History
15775 @cindex command history
15776
15777 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15778 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15779 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15780 history facility.
15781
15782 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15783 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15784 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15785
15786 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15787 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15788 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15789 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15790 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15791 pressed on a line by itself.
15792
15793 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15794 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15795 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15796 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15797
15798 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15799 history.
15800
15801 @table @code
15802 @cindex history substitution
15803 @cindex history file
15804 @kindex set history filename
15805 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15806 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15807 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15808 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15809 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15810 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15811 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15812 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15813 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15814 is not set.
15815
15816 @cindex save command history
15817 @kindex set history save
15818 @item set history save
15819 @itemx set history save on
15820 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15821 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15822
15823 @item set history save off
15824 Stop recording command history in a file.
15825
15826 @cindex history size
15827 @kindex set history size
15828 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15829 @item set history size @var{size}
15830 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15831 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15832 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15833 @end table
15834
15835 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15836 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15837
15838 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15839 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15840 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15841 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15842 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15843 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15844 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15845 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15846
15847 The commands to control history expansion are:
15848
15849 @table @code
15850 @item set history expansion on
15851 @itemx set history expansion
15852 @kindex set history expansion
15853 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15854
15855 @item set history expansion off
15856 Disable history expansion.
15857
15858 @c @group
15859 @kindex show history
15860 @item show history
15861 @itemx show history filename
15862 @itemx show history save
15863 @itemx show history size
15864 @itemx show history expansion
15865 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15866 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15867 @c @end group
15868 @end table
15869
15870 @table @code
15871 @kindex show commands
15872 @cindex show last commands
15873 @cindex display command history
15874 @item show commands
15875 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15876
15877 @item show commands @var{n}
15878 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15879
15880 @item show commands +
15881 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15882 @end table
15883
15884 @node Screen Size
15885 @section Screen Size
15886 @cindex size of screen
15887 @cindex pauses in output
15888
15889 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15890 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15891 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15892 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15893 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15894 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15895 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15896 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15897
15898 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15899 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15900 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15901 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15902 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15903 width} commands:
15904
15905 @table @code
15906 @kindex set height
15907 @kindex set width
15908 @kindex show width
15909 @kindex show height
15910 @item set height @var{lpp}
15911 @itemx show height
15912 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15913 @itemx show width
15914 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15915 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15916 commands display the current settings.
15917
15918 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15919 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15920 file or to an editor buffer.
15921
15922 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15923 from wrapping its output.
15924
15925 @item set pagination on
15926 @itemx set pagination off
15927 @kindex set pagination
15928 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15929 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15930
15931 @item show pagination
15932 @kindex show pagination
15933 Show the current pagination mode.
15934 @end table
15935
15936 @node Numbers
15937 @section Numbers
15938 @cindex number representation
15939 @cindex entering numbers
15940
15941 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15942 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15943 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15944 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15945 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15946 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15947 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15948 both input and output with the commands described below.
15949
15950 @table @code
15951 @kindex set input-radix
15952 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15953 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15954 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15955 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15956 example, any of
15957
15958 @smallexample
15959 set input-radix 012
15960 set input-radix 10.
15961 set input-radix 0xa
15962 @end smallexample
15963
15964 @noindent
15965 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15966 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15967 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15968 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15969 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15970 change the radix.
15971
15972 @kindex set output-radix
15973 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15974 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15975 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15976 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15977
15978 @kindex show input-radix
15979 @item show input-radix
15980 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15981
15982 @kindex show output-radix
15983 @item show output-radix
15984 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15985
15986 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15987 @itemx show radix
15988 @kindex set radix
15989 @kindex show radix
15990 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15991 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15992 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15993 default value of 10.
15994
15995 @end table
15996
15997 @node ABI
15998 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15999
16000 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16001 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16002 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16003 current ABI.
16004
16005 @cindex OS ABI
16006 @kindex set osabi
16007 @kindex show osabi
16008
16009 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16010 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16011 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16012 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16013 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16014 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16015 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16016 platform provides.
16017
16018 @table @code
16019 @item show osabi
16020 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16021
16022 @item set osabi
16023 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16024
16025 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16026 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16027 @end table
16028
16029 @cindex float promotion
16030
16031 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16032 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16033 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16034 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16035 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16036 @code{double} and then passed.
16037
16038 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16039 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16040 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16041
16042 @table @code
16043 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16044 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16045 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16046 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16047 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16048
16049 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16050 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16051 functions.
16052
16053 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16054 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16055 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16056 @end table
16057
16058 @kindex set cp-abi
16059 @kindex show cp-abi
16060 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16061 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16062 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16063 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16064 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16065 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16066 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16067 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16068 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16069 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16070 ``auto''.
16071
16072 @table @code
16073 @item show cp-abi
16074 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16075
16076 @item set cp-abi
16077 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16078
16079 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16080 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16081 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16082 @end table
16083
16084 @node Messages/Warnings
16085 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16086
16087 @cindex verbose operation
16088 @cindex optional warnings
16089 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16090 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16091 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16092 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16093
16094 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16095 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16096 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16097
16098 @table @code
16099 @kindex set verbose
16100 @item set verbose on
16101 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16102
16103 @item set verbose off
16104 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16105
16106 @kindex show verbose
16107 @item show verbose
16108 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16109 @end table
16110
16111 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16112 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16113 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16114 Symbol Files}).
16115
16116 @table @code
16117
16118 @kindex set complaints
16119 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16120 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16121 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16122 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16123 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16124
16125 @kindex show complaints
16126 @item show complaints
16127 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16128
16129 @end table
16130
16131 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16132 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16133 you try to run a program which is already running:
16134
16135 @smallexample
16136 (@value{GDBP}) run
16137 The program being debugged has been started already.
16138 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16139 @end smallexample
16140
16141 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16142 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16143
16144 @table @code
16145
16146 @kindex set confirm
16147 @cindex flinching
16148 @cindex confirmation
16149 @cindex stupid questions
16150 @item set confirm off
16151 Disables confirmation requests.
16152
16153 @item set confirm on
16154 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16155
16156 @kindex show confirm
16157 @item show confirm
16158 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16159
16160 @end table
16161
16162 @cindex command tracing
16163 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16164 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16165 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16166 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16167
16168 @table @code
16169 @kindex set trace-commands
16170 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16171 @item set trace-commands on
16172 Enable command tracing.
16173 @item set trace-commands off
16174 Disable command tracing.
16175 @item show trace-commands
16176 Display the current state of command tracing.
16177 @end table
16178
16179 @node Debugging Output
16180 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16181 @cindex optional debugging messages
16182
16183 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16184 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16185 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16186 section documents those commands.
16187
16188 @table @code
16189 @kindex set exec-done-display
16190 @item set exec-done-display
16191 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16192 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16193 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16194 @kindex show exec-done-display
16195 @item show exec-done-display
16196 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16197 notification.
16198 @kindex set debug
16199 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16200 @cindex architecture debugging info
16201 @item set debug arch
16202 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16203 @kindex show debug
16204 @item show debug arch
16205 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16206 @item set debug aix-thread
16207 @cindex AIX threads
16208 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16209 module.
16210 @item show debug aix-thread
16211 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16212 @item set debug event
16213 @cindex event debugging info
16214 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16215 default is off.
16216 @item show debug event
16217 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16218 info.
16219 @item set debug expression
16220 @cindex expression debugging info
16221 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16222 expression parsing. The default is off.
16223 @item show debug expression
16224 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16225 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16226 @item set debug frame
16227 @cindex frame debugging info
16228 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16229 default is off.
16230 @item show debug frame
16231 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16232 info.
16233 @item set debug infrun
16234 @cindex inferior debugging info
16235 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16236 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16237 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16238 @item show debug infrun
16239 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16240 @item set debug lin-lwp
16241 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16242 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16243 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16244 @item show debug lin-lwp
16245 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16246 @item set debug observer
16247 @cindex observer debugging info
16248 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16249 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16250 @item show debug observer
16251 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16252 @item set debug overload
16253 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16254 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16255 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16256 is off.
16257 @item show debug overload
16258 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16259 debugging info.
16260 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16261 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16262 @cindex debug remote protocol
16263 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16264 @cindex display remote packets
16265 @item set debug remote
16266 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16267 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16268 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16269 @item show debug remote
16270 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16271 @item set debug serial
16272 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16273 default is off.
16274 @item show debug serial
16275 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16276 info.
16277 @item set debug solib-frv
16278 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16279 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16280 @item show debug solib-frv
16281 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16282 messages.
16283 @item set debug target
16284 @cindex target debugging info
16285 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16286 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16287 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16288 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16289 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16290 @item show debug target
16291 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16292 info.
16293 @item set debugvarobj
16294 @cindex variable object debugging info
16295 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16296 info. The default is off.
16297 @item show debugvarobj
16298 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16299 debugging info.
16300 @item set debug xml
16301 @cindex XML parser debugging
16302 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16303 @item show debug xml
16304 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16305 @end table
16306
16307 @node Sequences
16308 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16309
16310 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16311 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16312 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16313 files.
16314
16315 @menu
16316 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16317 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16318 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16319 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16320 @end menu
16321
16322 @node Define
16323 @section User-defined Commands
16324
16325 @cindex user-defined command
16326 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16327 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16328 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16329 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16330 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16331 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16332
16333 @smallexample
16334 define adder
16335 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16336 end
16337 @end smallexample
16338
16339 @noindent
16340 To execute the command use:
16341
16342 @smallexample
16343 adder 1 2 3
16344 @end smallexample
16345
16346 @noindent
16347 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16348 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16349 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16350 functions calls.
16351
16352 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16353 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16354 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16355 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16356
16357 @smallexample
16358 define adder
16359 if $argc == 2
16360 print $arg0 + $arg1
16361 end
16362 if $argc == 3
16363 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16364 end
16365 end
16366 @end smallexample
16367
16368 @table @code
16369
16370 @kindex define
16371 @item define @var{commandname}
16372 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16373 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16374
16375 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16376 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16377 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16378
16379 @kindex document
16380 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16381 @item document @var{commandname}
16382 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16383 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16384 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16385 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16386 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16387 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16388
16389 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16390 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16391 does not change the documentation.
16392
16393 @kindex dont-repeat
16394 @cindex don't repeat command
16395 @item dont-repeat
16396 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16397 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16398 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16399
16400 @kindex help user-defined
16401 @item help user-defined
16402 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16403 (if any) for each.
16404
16405 @kindex show user
16406 @item show user
16407 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16408 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16409 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16410 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16411
16412 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16413 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16414 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16415 @item show max-user-call-depth
16416 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16417 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16418 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16419 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16420 @end table
16421
16422 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16423 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16424
16425 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16426 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16427 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16428
16429 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16430 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16431 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16432 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16433
16434 @node Hooks
16435 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16436 @cindex command hooks
16437 @cindex hooks, for commands
16438 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16439
16440 @kindex hook
16441 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16442 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16443 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16444 before that command.
16445
16446 @cindex hooks, post-command
16447 @kindex hookpost
16448 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16449 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16450 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16451 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16452 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16453
16454 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16455 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16456
16457 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16458 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16459
16460 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16461 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16462 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16463 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16464 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16465
16466 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16467 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16468 you could define:
16469
16470 @smallexample
16471 define hook-stop
16472 handle SIGALRM nopass
16473 end
16474
16475 define hook-run
16476 handle SIGALRM pass
16477 end
16478
16479 define hook-continue
16480 handle SIGALRM pass
16481 end
16482 @end smallexample
16483
16484 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16485 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16486 you could define:
16487
16488 @smallexample
16489 define hook-echo
16490 echo <<<---
16491 end
16492
16493 define hookpost-echo
16494 echo --->>>\n
16495 end
16496
16497 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16498 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16499 (@value{GDBP})
16500
16501 @end smallexample
16502
16503 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16504 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16505 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16506 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16507 @c or not?
16508 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16509 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16510 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16511
16512 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16513 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16514
16515 @node Command Files
16516 @section Command Files
16517
16518 @cindex command files
16519 @cindex scripting commands
16520 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16521 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16522 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16523 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16524 terminal.
16525
16526 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16527 command:
16528
16529 @table @code
16530 @kindex source
16531 @cindex execute commands from a file
16532 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16533 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16534 @end table
16535
16536 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16537 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16538 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16539 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16540 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16541
16542 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16543 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16544
16545 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16546 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16547 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16548
16549 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16550 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16551 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16552 when called from command files.
16553
16554 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16555 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16556 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16557 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16558 the next command.
16559
16560 @smallexample
16561 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16562 @end smallexample
16563
16564 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16565 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16566 would be directed to @file{log}.
16567
16568 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16569 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16570 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16571 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16572 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16573 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16574 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16575 conditionally, etc.
16576
16577 @table @code
16578 @kindex if
16579 @kindex else
16580 @item if
16581 @itemx else
16582 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16583 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16584 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16585 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16586 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16587 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16588 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16589
16590 @kindex while
16591 @item while
16592 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16593 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16594 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16595 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16596 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16597 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16598
16599 @kindex loop_break
16600 @item loop_break
16601 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16602 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16603 line.
16604
16605 @kindex loop_continue
16606 @item loop_continue
16607 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16608 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16609 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16610 the controlling expression.
16611
16612 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16613 @item end
16614 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16615 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16616 @end table
16617
16618
16619 @node Output
16620 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16621
16622 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16623 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16624 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16625 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16626 want.
16627
16628 @table @code
16629 @kindex echo
16630 @item echo @var{text}
16631 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16632 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16633 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16634 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16635 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16636 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16637 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16638 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16639 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16640 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16641 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16642
16643 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16644 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16645
16646 @smallexample
16647 echo This is some text\n\
16648 which is continued\n\
16649 onto several lines.\n
16650 @end smallexample
16651
16652 produces the same output as
16653
16654 @smallexample
16655 echo This is some text\n
16656 echo which is continued\n
16657 echo onto several lines.\n
16658 @end smallexample
16659
16660 @kindex output
16661 @item output @var{expression}
16662 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16663 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16664 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16665 on expressions.
16666
16667 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16668 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16669 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16670 Formats}, for more information.
16671
16672 @kindex printf
16673 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16674 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16675 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16676 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16677 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16678 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16679 executing the code below:
16680
16681 @smallexample
16682 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16683 @end smallexample
16684
16685 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16686 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16687 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16688 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16689 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16690 printed.
16691
16692 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16693
16694 @smallexample
16695 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16696 @end smallexample
16697
16698 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16699 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16700 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16701
16702 @itemize @bullet
16703 @item
16704 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16705
16706 @item
16707 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16708 width.
16709
16710 @item
16711 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16712 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16713
16714 @item
16715 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16716 supported.
16717
16718 @item
16719 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16720
16721 @item
16722 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16723 @end itemize
16724
16725 @noindent
16726 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16727 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16728 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16729 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16730
16731 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16732 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16733 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16734 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16735 supported.
16736
16737 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16738 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
16739 together with a floating point specifier.
16740 letters:
16741
16742 @itemize @bullet
16743 @item
16744 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16745
16746 @item
16747 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16748
16749 @item
16750 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16751 @end itemize
16752
16753 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16754 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
16755 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16756
16757 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16758 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16759
16760 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16761 @smallexample
16762 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16763 @end smallexample
16764
16765 @end table
16766
16767 @node Interpreters
16768 @chapter Command Interpreters
16769 @cindex command interpreters
16770
16771 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16772 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16773 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16774
16775 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16776 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16777 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16778 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16779
16780 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16781 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16782 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16783 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16784
16785 @table @code
16786 @item console
16787 @cindex console interpreter
16788 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16789 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16790 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16791
16792 @item mi
16793 @cindex mi interpreter
16794 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16795 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16796 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16797 Interface}.
16798
16799 @item mi2
16800 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16801 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16802
16803 @item mi1
16804 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16805 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16806
16807 @end table
16808
16809 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16810 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16811 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16812 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16813 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16814 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16815 the IDE inoperable!
16816
16817 @kindex interpreter-exec
16818 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16819 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16820 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16821 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16822
16823 @smallexample
16824 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16825 @end smallexample
16826
16827 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16828 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16829
16830 @node TUI
16831 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16832 @cindex TUI
16833 @cindex Text User Interface
16834
16835 @menu
16836 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16837 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16838 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16839 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16840 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16841 @end menu
16842
16843 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16844 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16845 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16846 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16847 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16848 is available.
16849
16850 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16851 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16852 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16853 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16854 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16855 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16856
16857 @node TUI Overview
16858 @section TUI Overview
16859
16860 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16861
16862 @table @emph
16863 @item command
16864 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16865 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16866 managed using readline.
16867
16868 @item source
16869 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16870 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16871
16872 @item assembly
16873 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16874
16875 @item register
16876 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16877 when their values change.
16878 @end table
16879
16880 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16881 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16882 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16883 indicates the breakpoint type:
16884
16885 @table @code
16886 @item B
16887 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16888
16889 @item b
16890 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16891
16892 @item H
16893 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16894
16895 @item h
16896 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16897 @end table
16898
16899 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16900
16901 @table @code
16902 @item +
16903 Breakpoint is enabled.
16904
16905 @item -
16906 Breakpoint is disabled.
16907 @end table
16908
16909 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16910 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16911 changes.
16912
16913 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16914 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16915 layouts:
16916
16917 @itemize @bullet
16918 @item
16919 source only,
16920
16921 @item
16922 assembly only,
16923
16924 @item
16925 source and assembly,
16926
16927 @item
16928 source and registers, or
16929
16930 @item
16931 assembly and registers.
16932 @end itemize
16933
16934 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16935
16936 @table @emph
16937 @item target
16938 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16939 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16940
16941 @item process
16942 Gives the current process or thread number.
16943 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16944
16945 @item function
16946 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16947 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16948 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16949 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16950
16951 @item line
16952 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16953 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16954
16955 @item pc
16956 Indicates the current program counter address.
16957 @end table
16958
16959 @node TUI Keys
16960 @section TUI Key Bindings
16961 @cindex TUI key bindings
16962
16963 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16964 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16965 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16966
16967 @table @kbd
16968 @kindex C-x C-a
16969 @item C-x C-a
16970 @kindex C-x a
16971 @itemx C-x a
16972 @kindex C-x A
16973 @itemx C-x A
16974 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16975 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16976 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16977 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16978 The screen is then refreshed.
16979
16980 @kindex C-x 1
16981 @item C-x 1
16982 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16983 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16984 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16985
16986 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16987
16988 @kindex C-x 2
16989 @item C-x 2
16990 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16991 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16992 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16993 previous layout and the new one.
16994
16995 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16996
16997 @kindex C-x o
16998 @item C-x o
16999 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17000 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17001 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17002
17003 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17004
17005 @kindex C-x s
17006 @item C-x s
17007 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17008 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17009 @end table
17010
17011 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17012
17013 @table @asis
17014 @kindex PgUp
17015 @item @key{PgUp}
17016 Scroll the active window one page up.
17017
17018 @kindex PgDn
17019 @item @key{PgDn}
17020 Scroll the active window one page down.
17021
17022 @kindex Up
17023 @item @key{Up}
17024 Scroll the active window one line up.
17025
17026 @kindex Down
17027 @item @key{Down}
17028 Scroll the active window one line down.
17029
17030 @kindex Left
17031 @item @key{Left}
17032 Scroll the active window one column left.
17033
17034 @kindex Right
17035 @item @key{Right}
17036 Scroll the active window one column right.
17037
17038 @kindex C-L
17039 @item @kbd{C-L}
17040 Refresh the screen.
17041 @end table
17042
17043 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17044 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17045 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17046 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17047 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17048
17049 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17050 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17051 @cindex TUI single key mode
17052
17053 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17054 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17055 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17056
17057 @table @kbd
17058 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17059 @item c
17060 continue
17061
17062 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17063 @item d
17064 down
17065
17066 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17067 @item f
17068 finish
17069
17070 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17071 @item n
17072 next
17073
17074 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17075 @item q
17076 exit the SingleKey mode.
17077
17078 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17079 @item r
17080 run
17081
17082 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17083 @item s
17084 step
17085
17086 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17087 @item u
17088 up
17089
17090 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17091 @item v
17092 info locals
17093
17094 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17095 @item w
17096 where
17097 @end table
17098
17099 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17100 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17101 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17102 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17103 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17104 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17105
17106
17107 @node TUI Commands
17108 @section TUI-specific Commands
17109 @cindex TUI commands
17110
17111 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17112 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17113 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17114 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17115
17116 @table @code
17117 @item info win
17118 @kindex info win
17119 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17120
17121 @item layout next
17122 @kindex layout
17123 Display the next layout.
17124
17125 @item layout prev
17126 Display the previous layout.
17127
17128 @item layout src
17129 Display the source window only.
17130
17131 @item layout asm
17132 Display the assembly window only.
17133
17134 @item layout split
17135 Display the source and assembly window.
17136
17137 @item layout regs
17138 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17139
17140 @item focus next
17141 @kindex focus
17142 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17143
17144 @item focus prev
17145 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17146
17147 @item focus src
17148 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17149
17150 @item focus asm
17151 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17152
17153 @item focus regs
17154 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17155
17156 @item focus cmd
17157 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17158
17159 @item refresh
17160 @kindex refresh
17161 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17162
17163 @item tui reg float
17164 @kindex tui reg
17165 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17166
17167 @item tui reg general
17168 Show the general registers in the register window.
17169
17170 @item tui reg next
17171 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17172 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17173 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17174 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17175
17176 @item tui reg system
17177 Show the system registers in the register window.
17178
17179 @item update
17180 @kindex update
17181 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17182
17183 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17184 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17185 @kindex winheight
17186 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17187 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17188 decrease it.
17189
17190 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17191 @kindex tabset
17192 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17193 @end table
17194
17195 @node TUI Configuration
17196 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17197 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17198
17199 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17200
17201 @table @code
17202 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17203 @kindex set tui border-kind
17204 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17205 The possible values are the following:
17206 @table @code
17207 @item space
17208 Use a space character to draw the border.
17209
17210 @item ascii
17211 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17212
17213 @item acs
17214 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17215 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17216 @end table
17217
17218 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17219 @kindex set tui border-mode
17220 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17221 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17222 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17223 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17224 @table @code
17225 @item normal
17226 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17227
17228 @item standout
17229 Use standout mode.
17230
17231 @item reverse
17232 Use reverse video mode.
17233
17234 @item half
17235 Use half bright mode.
17236
17237 @item half-standout
17238 Use half bright and standout mode.
17239
17240 @item bold
17241 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17242
17243 @item bold-standout
17244 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17245 @end table
17246 @end table
17247
17248 @node Emacs
17249 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17250
17251 @cindex Emacs
17252 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17253 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17254 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17255 @value{GDBN}.
17256
17257 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17258 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17259 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17260 created Emacs buffer.
17261 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17262
17263 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17264 things:
17265
17266 @itemize @bullet
17267 @item
17268 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17269 the GUD buffer.
17270
17271 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17272 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17273
17274 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17275 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17276 in this way.
17277
17278 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17279 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17280 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17281 stop.
17282
17283 @item
17284 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17285
17286 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17287 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17288 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17289 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17290 and the source.
17291
17292 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17293 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17294 @end itemize
17295
17296 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17297 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17298 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17299 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17300
17301 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17302 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17303 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17304 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17305 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17306 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17307 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17308 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17309 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17310
17311 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17312 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17313 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17314 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17315
17316 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17317 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17318 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17319 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17320 one you want.
17321
17322 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17323 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17324
17325 @table @kbd
17326 @item C-h m
17327 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17328
17329 @item C-c C-s
17330 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17331 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17332
17333 @item C-c C-n
17334 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17335 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17336 to show the current file and location.
17337
17338 @item C-c C-i
17339 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17340 display window accordingly.
17341
17342 @item C-c C-f
17343 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17344 @code{finish} command.
17345
17346 @item C-c C-r
17347 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17348 command.
17349
17350 @item C-c <
17351 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17352 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17353 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17354
17355 @item C-c >
17356 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17357 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17358 @end table
17359
17360 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17361 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17362
17363 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17364 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17365 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17366 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17367 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17368 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17369 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17370
17371 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17372 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17373 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17374 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17375 frame.
17376
17377 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17378 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17379 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17380 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17381 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17382 to correspond properly with the code.
17383
17384 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17385 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17386 Emacs Manual}).
17387
17388 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17389 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17390 @ignore
17391 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17392 @kindex Epoch
17393 @kindex inspect
17394
17395 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17396 called the @code{epoch}
17397 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17398 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17399 each value is printed in its own window.
17400 @end ignore
17401
17402
17403 @node GDB/MI
17404 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17405
17406 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17407
17408 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17409 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17410 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17411 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17412 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17413 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17414
17415 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17416 in the form of a reference manual.
17417
17418 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17419 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17420 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17421
17422 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17423
17424 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17425 This chapter uses the following notation:
17426
17427 @itemize @bullet
17428 @item
17429 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17430
17431 @item
17432 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17433 it may or may not be given.
17434
17435 @item
17436 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17437 may repeat zero or more times.
17438
17439 @item
17440 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17441 may repeat one or more times.
17442
17443 @item
17444 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17445 @end itemize
17446
17447 @ignore
17448 @heading Dependencies
17449 @end ignore
17450
17451 @menu
17452 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17453 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17454 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17455 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17456 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17457 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17458 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17459 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17460 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17461 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17462 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17463 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17464 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17465 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17466 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17467 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17468 @ignore
17469 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17470 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17471 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17472 @end ignore
17473 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17474 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17475 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17476 @end menu
17477
17478 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17479 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17480 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17481
17482 @menu
17483 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17484 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17485 @end menu
17486
17487 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17488 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17489
17490 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17491 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17492 @table @code
17493 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17494 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17495
17496 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17497 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17498 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17499
17500 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17501 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17502 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17503
17504 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17505 "any sequence of digits"
17506
17507 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17508 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17509
17510 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17511 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17512
17513 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17514 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17515
17516 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17517 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17518 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17519
17520 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17521 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17522
17523 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17524 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17525 @end table
17526
17527 @noindent
17528 Notes:
17529
17530 @itemize @bullet
17531 @item
17532 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17533 output is described below.
17534
17535 @item
17536 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17537 finishes.
17538
17539 @item
17540 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17541 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17542 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17543 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17544 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17545 @end itemize
17546
17547 Pragmatics:
17548
17549 @itemize @bullet
17550 @item
17551 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17552
17553 @item
17554 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17555 @end itemize
17556
17557 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17558 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17559
17560 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17561 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17562 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17563 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17564 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17565 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17566
17567 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17568 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17569 @var{token}.
17570
17571 @table @code
17572 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17573 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17574
17575 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17576 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17577
17578 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17579 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17580
17581 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17582 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17583
17584 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17585 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17586
17587 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17588 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17589
17590 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17591 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17592
17593 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17594 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17595
17596 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17597 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17598
17599 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17600 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17601 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17602
17603 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17604 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17605
17606 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17607 @code{ @var{string} }
17608
17609 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17610 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17611
17612 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17613 @code{@var{c-string}}
17614
17615 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17616 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17617
17618 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17619 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17620 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17621
17622 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17623 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17624
17625 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17626 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17627
17628 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17629 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17630
17631 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17632 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17633
17634 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17635 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17636
17637 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17638 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17639 @end table
17640
17641 @noindent
17642 Notes:
17643
17644 @itemize @bullet
17645 @item
17646 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17647
17648 @item
17649 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17650 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17651 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17652 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17653
17654 @item
17655 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17656 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17657 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17658 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17659
17660 @item
17661 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17662 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17663 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17664 @samp{*}.
17665
17666 @item
17667 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17668 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17669 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17670 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17671
17672 @item
17673 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17674 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17675 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17676 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17677
17678 @item
17679 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17680 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17681 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17682
17683 @item
17684 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17685 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17686 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17687 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17688
17689 @item
17690 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17691 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17692 @var{values}.
17693
17694
17695 @end itemize
17696
17697 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17698 details about the various output records.
17699
17700 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17701 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17702 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17703
17704 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17705 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17706
17707 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17708 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17709 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17710 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17711 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17712 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17713
17714 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17715 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17716 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17717
17718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17719 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17721 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17722
17723 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17724 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17725
17726 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17727 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17728 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17729 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17730 might change.
17731
17732 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17733 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17734 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17735 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17736
17737 @itemize @bullet
17738 @item
17739 New MI commands may be added.
17740
17741 @item
17742 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17743
17744 @item
17745 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17746 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17747
17748 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17749 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17750
17751 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17752 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17753 @end itemize
17754
17755 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17756 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17757 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17758 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17759 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17760
17761 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17762 @c version?
17763
17764 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17765 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17766 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17767 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17768 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17769 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17770 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17771 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17772 @cindex mailing lists
17773
17774 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17775 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17776 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17777
17778 @menu
17779 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17780 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17781 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17782 @end menu
17783
17784 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17785 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17786
17787 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17788 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17789 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17790 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17791
17792 @table @code
17793 @findex ^done
17794 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17795 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17796 values.
17797
17798 @item "^running"
17799 @findex ^running
17800 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17801 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17802 running.
17803
17804 @item "^connected"
17805 @findex ^connected
17806 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17807
17808 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17809 @findex ^error
17810 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17811 error message.
17812
17813 @item "^exit"
17814 @findex ^exit
17815 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17816
17817 @end table
17818
17819 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17820 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17821
17822 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17823 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17824 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17825 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17826 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17827
17828 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17829 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17830 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17831 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17832 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17833
17834 @table @code
17835 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17836 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17837 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17838
17839 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17840 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17841 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17842 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17843
17844 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17845 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17846 internals.
17847 @end table
17848
17849 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17850 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17851
17852 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17853 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17854 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17855 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17856 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17857 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17858
17859 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17860 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17861
17862 @table @code
17863 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17864 @end table
17865
17866 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17867
17868 @table @code
17869 @item breakpoint-hit
17870 A breakpoint was reached.
17871 @item watchpoint-trigger
17872 A watchpoint was triggered.
17873 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17874 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17875 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17876 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17877 @item function-finished
17878 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17879 @item location-reached
17880 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17881 @item watchpoint-scope
17882 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17883 @item end-stepping-range
17884 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17885 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17886 @item exited-signalled
17887 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17888 @item exited
17889 The inferior exited.
17890 @item exited-normally
17891 The inferior exited normally.
17892 @item signal-received
17893 A signal was received by the inferior.
17894 @end table
17895
17896
17897 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17898 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17899 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17900 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17901
17902 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17903 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17904 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17905 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17906
17907 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17908 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17909
17910 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17911
17912 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17913 information of the breakpoint.
17914
17915 @smallexample
17916 -> -break-insert main
17917 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17918 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17919 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17920 <- (gdb)
17921 @end smallexample
17922
17923 @subheading Program Execution
17924
17925 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17926 reason that execution stopped.
17927
17928 @smallexample
17929 -> -exec-run
17930 <- ^running
17931 <- (gdb)
17932 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17933 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17934 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17935 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17936 <- (gdb)
17937 -> -exec-continue
17938 <- ^running
17939 <- (gdb)
17940 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17941 <- (gdb)
17942 @end smallexample
17943
17944 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17945
17946 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17947
17948 @smallexample
17949 -> (gdb)
17950 <- -gdb-exit
17951 <- ^exit
17952 @end smallexample
17953
17954 @subheading A Bad Command
17955
17956 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17957
17958 @smallexample
17959 -> -rubbish
17960 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17961 <- (gdb)
17962 @end smallexample
17963
17964
17965 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17966 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17967 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17968
17969 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17970 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17971
17972 @subheading Motivation
17973
17974 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17975
17976 @subheading Introduction
17977
17978 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17979
17980 @subheading Commands
17981
17982 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17983
17984 @subsubheading Synopsis
17985
17986 @smallexample
17987 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17988 @end smallexample
17989
17990 @subsubheading Result
17991
17992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17993
17994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17995
17996 @subsubheading Example
17997
17998 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17999 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18000
18001
18002 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18003 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18004 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18005
18006 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18007 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18008 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18009 breakpoints.
18010
18011 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18012 @findex -break-after
18013
18014 @subsubheading Synopsis
18015
18016 @smallexample
18017 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18018 @end smallexample
18019
18020 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18021 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18022 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18023 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18024
18025 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18026
18027 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18028
18029 @subsubheading Example
18030
18031 @smallexample
18032 (gdb)
18033 -break-insert main
18034 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18035 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18036 (gdb)
18037 -break-after 1 3
18038 ~
18039 ^done
18040 (gdb)
18041 -break-list
18042 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18043 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18044 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18045 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18046 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18047 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18048 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18049 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18050 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18051 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18052 (gdb)
18053 @end smallexample
18054
18055 @ignore
18056 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18057 @findex -break-catch
18058
18059 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18060 @findex -break-commands
18061 @end ignore
18062
18063
18064 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18065 @findex -break-condition
18066
18067 @subsubheading Synopsis
18068
18069 @smallexample
18070 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18071 @end smallexample
18072
18073 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18074 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18075 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18076 command below).
18077
18078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18079
18080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18081
18082 @subsubheading Example
18083
18084 @smallexample
18085 (gdb)
18086 -break-condition 1 1
18087 ^done
18088 (gdb)
18089 -break-list
18090 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18091 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18092 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18093 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18094 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18095 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18096 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18097 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18098 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18099 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18100 (gdb)
18101 @end smallexample
18102
18103 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18104 @findex -break-delete
18105
18106 @subsubheading Synopsis
18107
18108 @smallexample
18109 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18110 @end smallexample
18111
18112 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18113 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18114
18115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18116
18117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18118
18119 @subsubheading Example
18120
18121 @smallexample
18122 (gdb)
18123 -break-delete 1
18124 ^done
18125 (gdb)
18126 -break-list
18127 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18128 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18129 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18130 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18131 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18132 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18133 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18134 body=[]@}
18135 (gdb)
18136 @end smallexample
18137
18138 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18139 @findex -break-disable
18140
18141 @subsubheading Synopsis
18142
18143 @smallexample
18144 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18145 @end smallexample
18146
18147 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18148 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18149
18150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18151
18152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18153
18154 @subsubheading Example
18155
18156 @smallexample
18157 (gdb)
18158 -break-disable 2
18159 ^done
18160 (gdb)
18161 -break-list
18162 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18163 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18164 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18165 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18166 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18167 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18168 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18169 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18170 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18171 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18172 (gdb)
18173 @end smallexample
18174
18175 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18176 @findex -break-enable
18177
18178 @subsubheading Synopsis
18179
18180 @smallexample
18181 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18182 @end smallexample
18183
18184 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18185
18186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18187
18188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18189
18190 @subsubheading Example
18191
18192 @smallexample
18193 (gdb)
18194 -break-enable 2
18195 ^done
18196 (gdb)
18197 -break-list
18198 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18199 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18200 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18201 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18202 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18203 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18204 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18205 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18206 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18207 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18208 (gdb)
18209 @end smallexample
18210
18211 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18212 @findex -break-info
18213
18214 @subsubheading Synopsis
18215
18216 @smallexample
18217 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 @c REDUNDANT???
18221 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18222
18223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18224
18225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18226
18227 @subsubheading Example
18228 N.A.
18229
18230 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18231 @findex -break-insert
18232
18233 @subsubheading Synopsis
18234
18235 @smallexample
18236 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18237 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18238 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18239 @end smallexample
18240
18241 @noindent
18242 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18243
18244 @itemize @bullet
18245 @item function
18246 @c @item +offset
18247 @c @item -offset
18248 @c @item linenum
18249 @item filename:linenum
18250 @item filename:function
18251 @item *address
18252 @end itemize
18253
18254 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18255
18256 @table @samp
18257 @item -t
18258 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18259 @item -h
18260 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18261 @item -c @var{condition}
18262 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18263 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18264 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18265 @item -f
18266 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18267 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18268 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18269 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18270 cannot be parsed.
18271 @end table
18272
18273 @subsubheading Result
18274
18275 The result is in the form:
18276
18277 @smallexample
18278 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18279 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18280 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18281 times="@var{times}"@}
18282 @end smallexample
18283
18284 @noindent
18285 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18286 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18287 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18288 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18289 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18290 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18291 which use the same output).
18292
18293 Note: this format is open to change.
18294 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18295
18296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18297
18298 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18299 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18300
18301 @subsubheading Example
18302
18303 @smallexample
18304 (gdb)
18305 -break-insert main
18306 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18307 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18308 (gdb)
18309 -break-insert -t foo
18310 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18311 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18312 (gdb)
18313 -break-list
18314 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18315 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18316 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18317 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18318 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18319 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18320 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18321 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18322 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18323 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18324 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18325 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18326 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18327 (gdb)
18328 -break-insert -r foo.*
18329 ~int foo(int, int);
18330 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18331 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18332 (gdb)
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18336 @findex -break-list
18337
18338 @subsubheading Synopsis
18339
18340 @smallexample
18341 -break-list
18342 @end smallexample
18343
18344 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18345
18346 @table @samp
18347 @item Number
18348 number of the breakpoint
18349 @item Type
18350 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18351 @item Disposition
18352 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18353 or @samp{nokeep}
18354 @item Enabled
18355 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18356 @item Address
18357 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18358 @item What
18359 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18360 name, line number
18361 @item Times
18362 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18363 @end table
18364
18365 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18366 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18367
18368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18369
18370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18371
18372 @subsubheading Example
18373
18374 @smallexample
18375 (gdb)
18376 -break-list
18377 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18378 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18379 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18380 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18381 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18382 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18383 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18384 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18385 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18386 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18387 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18388 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18389 (gdb)
18390 @end smallexample
18391
18392 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18393
18394 @smallexample
18395 (gdb)
18396 -break-list
18397 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18398 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18399 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18400 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18401 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18402 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18403 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18404 body=[]@}
18405 (gdb)
18406 @end smallexample
18407
18408 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18409 @findex -break-watch
18410
18411 @subsubheading Synopsis
18412
18413 @smallexample
18414 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18418 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18419 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18420 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18421 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18422 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18423 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18424 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18425
18426 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18427 breakpoints inserted.
18428
18429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18430
18431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18432 @samp{rwatch}.
18433
18434 @subsubheading Example
18435
18436 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18437
18438 @smallexample
18439 (gdb)
18440 -break-watch x
18441 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18442 (gdb)
18443 -exec-continue
18444 ^running
18445 (gdb)
18446 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18447 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18448 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18449 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18450 (gdb)
18451 @end smallexample
18452
18453 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18454 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18455 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18456
18457 @smallexample
18458 (gdb)
18459 -break-watch C
18460 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18461 (gdb)
18462 -exec-continue
18463 ^running
18464 (gdb)
18465 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18466 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18467 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18468 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18469 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18470 (gdb)
18471 -exec-continue
18472 ^running
18473 (gdb)
18474 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18475 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18476 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18477 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18478 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18479 (gdb)
18480 @end smallexample
18481
18482 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18483 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18484 deleted.
18485
18486 @smallexample
18487 (gdb)
18488 -break-watch C
18489 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18490 (gdb)
18491 -break-list
18492 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18493 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18494 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18495 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18496 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18497 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18498 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18499 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18500 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18501 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18502 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18503 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18504 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18505 (gdb)
18506 -exec-continue
18507 ^running
18508 (gdb)
18509 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18510 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18511 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18512 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18513 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18514 (gdb)
18515 -break-list
18516 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18517 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18518 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18519 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18520 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18521 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18522 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18523 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18524 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18525 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18526 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18527 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18528 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18529 (gdb)
18530 -exec-continue
18531 ^running
18532 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18533 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18534 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18535 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18536 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18537 (gdb)
18538 -break-list
18539 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18540 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18541 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18542 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18543 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18544 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18545 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18546 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18547 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18548 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18549 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18550 times="1"@}]@}
18551 (gdb)
18552 @end smallexample
18553
18554 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18555 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18556 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18557
18558 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18559 @findex -exec-arguments
18560
18561
18562 @subsubheading Synopsis
18563
18564 @smallexample
18565 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18566 @end smallexample
18567
18568 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18569 @samp{-exec-run}.
18570
18571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18572
18573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18574
18575 @subsubheading Example
18576
18577 @c FIXME!
18578 Don't have one around.
18579
18580
18581 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18582 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18583
18584 @subsubheading Synopsis
18585
18586 @smallexample
18587 -exec-show-arguments
18588 @end smallexample
18589
18590 Print the arguments of the program.
18591
18592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18593
18594 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18595
18596 @subsubheading Example
18597 N.A.
18598
18599
18600 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18601 @findex -environment-cd
18602
18603 @subsubheading Synopsis
18604
18605 @smallexample
18606 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18607 @end smallexample
18608
18609 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18610
18611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18612
18613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18614
18615 @subsubheading Example
18616
18617 @smallexample
18618 (gdb)
18619 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18620 ^done
18621 (gdb)
18622 @end smallexample
18623
18624
18625 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18626 @findex -environment-directory
18627
18628 @subsubheading Synopsis
18629
18630 @smallexample
18631 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18632 @end smallexample
18633
18634 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18635 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18636 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18637 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18638 occurs as normal.
18639 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18640 multiple directories in a single command
18641 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18642 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18643 If blanks are needed as
18644 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18645 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18646 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18647 character must not be used
18648 in any directory name.
18649 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18650
18651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18652
18653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18654
18655 @subsubheading Example
18656
18657 @smallexample
18658 (gdb)
18659 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18660 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18661 (gdb)
18662 -environment-directory ""
18663 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18664 (gdb)
18665 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18666 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18667 (gdb)
18668 -environment-directory -r
18669 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18670 (gdb)
18671 @end smallexample
18672
18673
18674 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18675 @findex -environment-path
18676
18677 @subsubheading Synopsis
18678
18679 @smallexample
18680 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18681 @end smallexample
18682
18683 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18684 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18685 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18686 supplied in addition to the
18687 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18688 occurs as normal.
18689 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18690 multiple directories in a single command
18691 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18692 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18693 If blanks are needed as
18694 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18695 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18696 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18697 character must not be used
18698 in any directory name.
18699 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18700
18701
18702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18703
18704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18705
18706 @subsubheading Example
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 (gdb)
18710 -environment-path
18711 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18712 (gdb)
18713 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18714 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18715 (gdb)
18716 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18717 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18718 (gdb)
18719 @end smallexample
18720
18721
18722 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18723 @findex -environment-pwd
18724
18725 @subsubheading Synopsis
18726
18727 @smallexample
18728 -environment-pwd
18729 @end smallexample
18730
18731 Show the current working directory.
18732
18733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18734
18735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18736
18737 @subsubheading Example
18738
18739 @smallexample
18740 (gdb)
18741 -environment-pwd
18742 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18743 (gdb)
18744 @end smallexample
18745
18746 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18747 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18748 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18749
18750
18751 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18752 @findex -thread-info
18753
18754 @subsubheading Synopsis
18755
18756 @smallexample
18757 -thread-info
18758 @end smallexample
18759
18760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18761
18762 No equivalent.
18763
18764 @subsubheading Example
18765 N.A.
18766
18767
18768 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18769 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18770
18771 @subsubheading Synopsis
18772
18773 @smallexample
18774 -thread-list-all-threads
18775 @end smallexample
18776
18777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18778
18779 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18780
18781 @subsubheading Example
18782 N.A.
18783
18784
18785 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18786 @findex -thread-list-ids
18787
18788 @subsubheading Synopsis
18789
18790 @smallexample
18791 -thread-list-ids
18792 @end smallexample
18793
18794 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18795 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18796
18797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18798
18799 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18800
18801 @subsubheading Example
18802
18803 No threads present, besides the main process:
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 (gdb)
18807 -thread-list-ids
18808 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18809 (gdb)
18810 @end smallexample
18811
18812
18813 Several threads:
18814
18815 @smallexample
18816 (gdb)
18817 -thread-list-ids
18818 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18819 number-of-threads="3"
18820 (gdb)
18821 @end smallexample
18822
18823
18824 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18825 @findex -thread-select
18826
18827 @subsubheading Synopsis
18828
18829 @smallexample
18830 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18831 @end smallexample
18832
18833 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18834 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18835
18836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18837
18838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18839
18840 @subsubheading Example
18841
18842 @smallexample
18843 (gdb)
18844 -exec-next
18845 ^running
18846 (gdb)
18847 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18848 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18849 (gdb)
18850 -thread-list-ids
18851 ^done,
18852 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18853 number-of-threads="3"
18854 (gdb)
18855 -thread-select 3
18856 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18857 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18858 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18859 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18860 (gdb)
18861 @end smallexample
18862
18863 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18864 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18865 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18866
18867 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18868 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18869 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18870 other cases.
18871
18872 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18873 @findex -exec-continue
18874
18875 @subsubheading Synopsis
18876
18877 @smallexample
18878 -exec-continue
18879 @end smallexample
18880
18881 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18882 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18883
18884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18885
18886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18887
18888 @subsubheading Example
18889
18890 @smallexample
18891 -exec-continue
18892 ^running
18893 (gdb)
18894 @@Hello world
18895 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18896 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18897 (gdb)
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900
18901 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18902 @findex -exec-finish
18903
18904 @subsubheading Synopsis
18905
18906 @smallexample
18907 -exec-finish
18908 @end smallexample
18909
18910 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18911 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18912
18913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18914
18915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18916
18917 @subsubheading Example
18918
18919 Function returning @code{void}.
18920
18921 @smallexample
18922 -exec-finish
18923 ^running
18924 (gdb)
18925 @@hello from foo
18926 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18927 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18928 (gdb)
18929 @end smallexample
18930
18931 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18932 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18933 value itself.
18934
18935 @smallexample
18936 -exec-finish
18937 ^running
18938 (gdb)
18939 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18940 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18941 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18942 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18943 (gdb)
18944 @end smallexample
18945
18946
18947 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18948 @findex -exec-interrupt
18949
18950 @subsubheading Synopsis
18951
18952 @smallexample
18953 -exec-interrupt
18954 @end smallexample
18955
18956 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18957 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18958 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18959 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18960 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18961
18962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18963
18964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18965
18966 @subsubheading Example
18967
18968 @smallexample
18969 (gdb)
18970 111-exec-continue
18971 111^running
18972
18973 (gdb)
18974 222-exec-interrupt
18975 222^done
18976 (gdb)
18977 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18978 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18979 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18980 (gdb)
18981
18982 (gdb)
18983 -exec-interrupt
18984 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18985 (gdb)
18986 @end smallexample
18987
18988
18989 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18990 @findex -exec-next
18991
18992 @subsubheading Synopsis
18993
18994 @smallexample
18995 -exec-next
18996 @end smallexample
18997
18998 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18999 of the next source line is reached.
19000
19001 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19002
19003 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19004
19005 @subsubheading Example
19006
19007 @smallexample
19008 -exec-next
19009 ^running
19010 (gdb)
19011 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19012 (gdb)
19013 @end smallexample
19014
19015
19016 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19017 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19018
19019 @subsubheading Synopsis
19020
19021 @smallexample
19022 -exec-next-instruction
19023 @end smallexample
19024
19025 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19026 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19027 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19028 printed as well.
19029
19030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19031
19032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19033
19034 @subsubheading Example
19035
19036 @smallexample
19037 (gdb)
19038 -exec-next-instruction
19039 ^running
19040
19041 (gdb)
19042 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19043 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19044 (gdb)
19045 @end smallexample
19046
19047
19048 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19049 @findex -exec-return
19050
19051 @subsubheading Synopsis
19052
19053 @smallexample
19054 -exec-return
19055 @end smallexample
19056
19057 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19058 Displays the new current frame.
19059
19060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19061
19062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19063
19064 @subsubheading Example
19065
19066 @smallexample
19067 (gdb)
19068 200-break-insert callee4
19069 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19070 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19071 (gdb)
19072 000-exec-run
19073 000^running
19074 (gdb)
19075 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19076 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19077 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19078 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19079 (gdb)
19080 205-break-delete
19081 205^done
19082 (gdb)
19083 111-exec-return
19084 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19085 args=[@{name="strarg",
19086 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19087 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19088 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19089 (gdb)
19090 @end smallexample
19091
19092
19093 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19094 @findex -exec-run
19095
19096 @subsubheading Synopsis
19097
19098 @smallexample
19099 -exec-run
19100 @end smallexample
19101
19102 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19103 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19104 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19105 the program has exited exceptionally.
19106
19107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19108
19109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19110
19111 @subsubheading Examples
19112
19113 @smallexample
19114 (gdb)
19115 -break-insert main
19116 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19117 (gdb)
19118 -exec-run
19119 ^running
19120 (gdb)
19121 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19122 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19123 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19124 (gdb)
19125 @end smallexample
19126
19127 @noindent
19128 Program exited normally:
19129
19130 @smallexample
19131 (gdb)
19132 -exec-run
19133 ^running
19134 (gdb)
19135 x = 55
19136 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19137 (gdb)
19138 @end smallexample
19139
19140 @noindent
19141 Program exited exceptionally:
19142
19143 @smallexample
19144 (gdb)
19145 -exec-run
19146 ^running
19147 (gdb)
19148 x = 55
19149 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19150 (gdb)
19151 @end smallexample
19152
19153 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19154 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19155
19156 @smallexample
19157 (gdb)
19158 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19159 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19160 @end smallexample
19161
19162
19163 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19164
19165
19166 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19167 @findex -exec-step
19168
19169 @subsubheading Synopsis
19170
19171 @smallexample
19172 -exec-step
19173 @end smallexample
19174
19175 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19176 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19177 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19178 function.
19179
19180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19181
19182 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19183
19184 @subsubheading Example
19185
19186 Stepping into a function:
19187
19188 @smallexample
19189 -exec-step
19190 ^running
19191 (gdb)
19192 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19193 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19194 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19195 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19196 (gdb)
19197 @end smallexample
19198
19199 Regular stepping:
19200
19201 @smallexample
19202 -exec-step
19203 ^running
19204 (gdb)
19205 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19206 (gdb)
19207 @end smallexample
19208
19209
19210 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19211 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19212
19213 @subsubheading Synopsis
19214
19215 @smallexample
19216 -exec-step-instruction
19217 @end smallexample
19218
19219 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19220 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19221 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19222 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19223 well.
19224
19225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19226
19227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19228
19229 @subsubheading Example
19230
19231 @smallexample
19232 (gdb)
19233 -exec-step-instruction
19234 ^running
19235
19236 (gdb)
19237 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19238 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19239 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19240 (gdb)
19241 -exec-step-instruction
19242 ^running
19243
19244 (gdb)
19245 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19246 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19247 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19248 (gdb)
19249 @end smallexample
19250
19251
19252 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19253 @findex -exec-until
19254
19255 @subsubheading Synopsis
19256
19257 @smallexample
19258 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19259 @end smallexample
19260
19261 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19262 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19263 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19264 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19265
19266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19267
19268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19269
19270 @subsubheading Example
19271
19272 @smallexample
19273 (gdb)
19274 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19275 ^running
19276 (gdb)
19277 x = 55
19278 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19279 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19280 (gdb)
19281 @end smallexample
19282
19283 @ignore
19284 @subheading -file-clear
19285 Is this going away????
19286 @end ignore
19287
19288 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19289 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19290 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19291
19292
19293 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19294 @findex -stack-info-frame
19295
19296 @subsubheading Synopsis
19297
19298 @smallexample
19299 -stack-info-frame
19300 @end smallexample
19301
19302 Get info on the selected frame.
19303
19304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19305
19306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19307 (without arguments).
19308
19309 @subsubheading Example
19310
19311 @smallexample
19312 (gdb)
19313 -stack-info-frame
19314 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19315 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19316 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19317 (gdb)
19318 @end smallexample
19319
19320 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19321 @findex -stack-info-depth
19322
19323 @subsubheading Synopsis
19324
19325 @smallexample
19326 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19327 @end smallexample
19328
19329 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19330 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19331
19332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19333
19334 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19335
19336 @subsubheading Example
19337
19338 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 (gdb)
19342 -stack-info-depth
19343 ^done,depth="12"
19344 (gdb)
19345 -stack-info-depth 4
19346 ^done,depth="4"
19347 (gdb)
19348 -stack-info-depth 12
19349 ^done,depth="12"
19350 (gdb)
19351 -stack-info-depth 11
19352 ^done,depth="11"
19353 (gdb)
19354 -stack-info-depth 13
19355 ^done,depth="12"
19356 (gdb)
19357 @end smallexample
19358
19359 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19360 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19361
19362 @subsubheading Synopsis
19363
19364 @smallexample
19365 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19366 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19367 @end smallexample
19368
19369 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19370 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19371 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19372 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19373 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19374 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19375 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19376 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19377
19378 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19379 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19380 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19381
19382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19383
19384 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19385 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19386 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19387
19388 @subsubheading Example
19389
19390 @smallexample
19391 (gdb)
19392 -stack-list-frames
19393 ^done,
19394 stack=[
19395 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19396 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19397 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19398 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19399 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19400 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19401 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19402 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19403 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19404 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19405 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19406 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19407 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19408 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19409 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19410 (gdb)
19411 -stack-list-arguments 0
19412 ^done,
19413 stack-args=[
19414 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19415 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19416 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19417 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19418 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19419 (gdb)
19420 -stack-list-arguments 1
19421 ^done,
19422 stack-args=[
19423 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19424 frame=@{level="1",
19425 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19426 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19427 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19428 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19429 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19430 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19431 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19432 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19433 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19434 (gdb)
19435 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19436 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19437 (gdb)
19438 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19439 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19440 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19441 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19442 (gdb)
19443 @end smallexample
19444
19445 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19446
19447
19448 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19449 @findex -stack-list-frames
19450
19451 @subsubheading Synopsis
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19455 @end smallexample
19456
19457 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19458 following info:
19459
19460 @table @samp
19461 @item @var{level}
19462 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19463 @item @var{addr}
19464 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19465 @item @var{func}
19466 Function name.
19467 @item @var{file}
19468 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19469 @item @var{line}
19470 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19471 @end table
19472
19473 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19474 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19475 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19476 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19477 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19478 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19479 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19480
19481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19482
19483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19484
19485 @subsubheading Example
19486
19487 Full stack backtrace:
19488
19489 @smallexample
19490 (gdb)
19491 -stack-list-frames
19492 ^done,stack=
19493 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19494 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19495 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19497 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19498 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19499 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19500 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19501 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19502 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19503 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19504 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19505 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19506 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19507 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19508 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19509 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19510 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19511 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19512 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19513 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19514 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19515 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19516 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19517 (gdb)
19518 @end smallexample
19519
19520 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19521
19522 @smallexample
19523 (gdb)
19524 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19525 ^done,stack=
19526 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19527 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19528 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19529 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19530 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19531 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19532 (gdb)
19533 @end smallexample
19534
19535 Show a single frame:
19536
19537 @smallexample
19538 (gdb)
19539 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19540 ^done,stack=
19541 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19542 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19543 (gdb)
19544 @end smallexample
19545
19546
19547 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19548 @findex -stack-list-locals
19549
19550 @subsubheading Synopsis
19551
19552 @smallexample
19553 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19554 @end smallexample
19555
19556 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19557 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19558 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19559 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19560 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19561 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19562 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19563 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19564 more detail.
19565
19566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19567
19568 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19569
19570 @subsubheading Example
19571
19572 @smallexample
19573 (gdb)
19574 -stack-list-locals 0
19575 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19576 (gdb)
19577 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19578 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19579 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19580 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19581 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19582 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19583 (gdb)
19584 @end smallexample
19585
19586
19587 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19588 @findex -stack-select-frame
19589
19590 @subsubheading Synopsis
19591
19592 @smallexample
19593 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19594 @end smallexample
19595
19596 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19597 the stack.
19598
19599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19600
19601 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19602 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19603
19604 @subsubheading Example
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 (gdb)
19608 -stack-select-frame 2
19609 ^done
19610 (gdb)
19611 @end smallexample
19612
19613 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19614 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19615 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19616
19617 @ignore
19618
19619 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19620
19621 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19622 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19623 used by @code{Insight}.
19624
19625 The two main reasons for that are:
19626
19627 @enumerate 1
19628 @item
19629 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19630
19631 @item
19632 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19633 now).
19634 @end enumerate
19635
19636 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19637 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19638 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19639 hints about their use.
19640
19641 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19642 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19643 least, the following operations:
19644
19645 @itemize @bullet
19646 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19647 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19648 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19649 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19650 @end itemize
19651
19652 @end ignore
19653
19654 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19655
19656 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19657
19658 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19659 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19660 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19661 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19662 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19663 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19664 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19665 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19666 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19667 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19668 object, or to change display format.
19669
19670 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19671 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19672 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19673 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19674 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19675 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19676 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19677 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19678 child will be created.
19679
19680 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19681 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19682 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19683 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19684 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19685
19686 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19687 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19688 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19689 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19690 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19691 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19692 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19693 variables that frontend has created.
19694
19695 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19696 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19697 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19698 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19699 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19700 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19701 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19702 implicitly updated.
19703
19704 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19705 access this functionality:
19706
19707 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19708 @item @strong{Operation}
19709 @tab @strong{Description}
19710
19711 @item @code{-var-create}
19712 @tab create a variable object
19713 @item @code{-var-delete}
19714 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19715 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19716 @tab set the display format of this variable
19717 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19718 @tab show the display format of this variable
19719 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19720 @tab tells how many children this object has
19721 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19722 @tab return a list of the object's children
19723 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19724 @tab show the type of this variable object
19725 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19726 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19727 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19728 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19729 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19730 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19731 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19732 @tab get the value of this variable
19733 @item @code{-var-assign}
19734 @tab set the value of this variable
19735 @item @code{-var-update}
19736 @tab update the variable and its children
19737 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19738 @tab set frozeness attribute
19739 @end multitable
19740
19741 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19742 how it can be used.
19743
19744 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19745
19746 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19747 @findex -var-create
19748
19749 @subsubheading Synopsis
19750
19751 @smallexample
19752 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19753 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19754 @end smallexample
19755
19756 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19757 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19758 register.
19759
19760 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19761 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19762 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19763 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19764 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19765
19766 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19767 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19768 frame should be used.
19769
19770 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19771 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19772
19773 @itemize @bullet
19774 @item
19775 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19776
19777 @item
19778 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19779
19780 @item
19781 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19782 @end itemize
19783
19784 @subsubheading Result
19785
19786 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19787 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19788 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19789
19790 @smallexample
19791 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19792 @end smallexample
19793
19794
19795 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19796 @findex -var-delete
19797
19798 @subsubheading Synopsis
19799
19800 @smallexample
19801 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19802 @end smallexample
19803
19804 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19805 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19806
19807 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19808
19809
19810 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19811 @findex -var-set-format
19812
19813 @subsubheading Synopsis
19814
19815 @smallexample
19816 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19817 @end smallexample
19818
19819 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19820 @var{format-spec}.
19821
19822 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19823
19824 @smallexample
19825 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19826 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19827 @end smallexample
19828
19829 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19830 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19831 for pointers, etc.).
19832
19833 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19834 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19835
19836 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19837 @findex -var-show-format
19838
19839 @subsubheading Synopsis
19840
19841 @smallexample
19842 -var-show-format @var{name}
19843 @end smallexample
19844
19845 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19846
19847 @smallexample
19848 @var{format} @expansion{}
19849 @var{format-spec}
19850 @end smallexample
19851
19852
19853 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19854 @findex -var-info-num-children
19855
19856 @subsubheading Synopsis
19857
19858 @smallexample
19859 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19860 @end smallexample
19861
19862 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19863
19864 @smallexample
19865 numchild=@var{n}
19866 @end smallexample
19867
19868
19869 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19870 @findex -var-list-children
19871
19872 @subsubheading Synopsis
19873
19874 @smallexample
19875 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19876 @end smallexample
19877 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19878
19879 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19880 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19881 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19882 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19883 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19884 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19885 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19886 and unions.
19887
19888 @subsubheading Example
19889
19890 @smallexample
19891 (gdb)
19892 -var-list-children n
19893 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19894 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19895 (gdb)
19896 -var-list-children --all-values n
19897 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19898 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19899 @end smallexample
19900
19901
19902 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19903 @findex -var-info-type
19904
19905 @subsubheading Synopsis
19906
19907 @smallexample
19908 -var-info-type @var{name}
19909 @end smallexample
19910
19911 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19912 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19913 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19914
19915 @smallexample
19916 type=@var{typename}
19917 @end smallexample
19918
19919
19920 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19921 @findex -var-info-expression
19922
19923 @subsubheading Synopsis
19924
19925 @smallexample
19926 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19927 @end smallexample
19928
19929 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
19930 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
19931 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
19932
19933 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
19934 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
19935
19936 @smallexample
19937 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
19938 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
19939 @end smallexample
19940
19941 @noindent
19942 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19943
19944 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
19945 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
19946 is of limited use.
19947
19948 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
19949 @findex -var-info-path-expression
19950
19951 @subsubheading Synopsis
19952
19953 @smallexample
19954 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
19955 @end smallexample
19956
19957 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
19958 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
19959 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
19960 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
19961 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
19962 watchpoint from a variable object.
19963
19964 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
19965 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
19966 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
19967 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
19968 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
19969 @smallexample
19970 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
19971 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
19972 @end smallexample
19973
19974 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19975 @findex -var-show-attributes
19976
19977 @subsubheading Synopsis
19978
19979 @smallexample
19980 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19981 @end smallexample
19982
19983 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19984
19985 @smallexample
19986 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19987 @end smallexample
19988
19989 @noindent
19990 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19991
19992 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19993 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19994
19995 @subsubheading Synopsis
19996
19997 @smallexample
19998 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19999 @end smallexample
20000
20001 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20002 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
20003 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20004
20005 @smallexample
20006 value=@var{value}
20007 @end smallexample
20008
20009 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20010 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20011
20012 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20013 @findex -var-assign
20014
20015 @subsubheading Synopsis
20016
20017 @smallexample
20018 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20019 @end smallexample
20020
20021 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20022 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20023 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20024 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20025
20026 @subsubheading Example
20027
20028 @smallexample
20029 (gdb)
20030 -var-assign var1 3
20031 ^done,value="3"
20032 (gdb)
20033 -var-update *
20034 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20035 (gdb)
20036 @end smallexample
20037
20038 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20039 @findex -var-update
20040
20041 @subsubheading Synopsis
20042
20043 @smallexample
20044 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20045 @end smallexample
20046
20047 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20048 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20049 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20050 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20051 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20052 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20053 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20054 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20055 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20056 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
20057 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20058 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20059 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20060
20061
20062 @subsubheading Example
20063
20064 @smallexample
20065 (gdb)
20066 -var-assign var1 3
20067 ^done,value="3"
20068 (gdb)
20069 -var-update --all-values var1
20070 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20071 type_changed="false"@}]
20072 (gdb)
20073 @end smallexample
20074
20075 @anchor{-var-update}
20076 The field in_scope may take three values:
20077
20078 @table @code
20079 @item "true"
20080 The variable object's current value is valid.
20081
20082 @item "false"
20083 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20084 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20085 scope.
20086
20087 @item "invalid"
20088 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20089 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20090 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20091 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20092 objects.
20093 @end table
20094
20095 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20096 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20097
20098 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20099 @findex -var-set-frozen
20100 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20101
20102 @subsubheading Synopsis
20103
20104 @smallexample
20105 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20106 @end smallexample
20107
20108 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20109 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20110 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20111 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20112 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20113 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20114 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20115 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20116 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20117 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20118 @code{-var-update} does.
20119
20120 @subsubheading Example
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 (gdb)
20124 -var-set-frozen V 1
20125 ^done
20126 (gdb)
20127 @end smallexample
20128
20129
20130 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20131 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20132 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20133
20134 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20135 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20136 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20137 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20138
20139 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20140 @c @subheading -data-assign
20141 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20142 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20143 @c set variable
20144 @c @subsubheading Example
20145 @c N.A.
20146
20147 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20148 @findex -data-disassemble
20149
20150 @subsubheading Synopsis
20151
20152 @smallexample
20153 -data-disassemble
20154 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20155 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20156 -- @var{mode}
20157 @end smallexample
20158
20159 @noindent
20160 Where:
20161
20162 @table @samp
20163 @item @var{start-addr}
20164 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20165 @item @var{end-addr}
20166 is the end address
20167 @item @var{filename}
20168 is the name of the file to disassemble
20169 @item @var{linenum}
20170 is the line number to disassemble around
20171 @item @var{lines}
20172 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20173 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20174 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20175 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20176 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20177 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20178 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20179 are displayed.
20180 @item @var{mode}
20181 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20182 disassembly).
20183 @end table
20184
20185 @subsubheading Result
20186
20187 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20188
20189 @itemize @bullet
20190 @item Address
20191 @item Func-name
20192 @item Offset
20193 @item Instruction
20194 @end itemize
20195
20196 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20197 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20198
20199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20200
20201 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20202
20203 @subsubheading Example
20204
20205 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20206
20207 @smallexample
20208 (gdb)
20209 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20210 ^done,
20211 asm_insns=[
20212 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20213 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20214 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20215 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20216 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20217 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20218 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20219 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20220 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20221 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20222 (gdb)
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20226 @code{main}.
20227
20228 @smallexample
20229 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20230 ^done,asm_insns=[
20231 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20232 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20233 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20234 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20235 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20236 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20237 [@dots{}]
20238 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20239 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20240 (gdb)
20241 @end smallexample
20242
20243 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20244
20245 @smallexample
20246 (gdb)
20247 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20248 ^done,asm_insns=[
20249 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20250 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20251 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20252 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20253 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20254 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20255 (gdb)
20256 @end smallexample
20257
20258 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 (gdb)
20262 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20263 ^done,asm_insns=[
20264 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20265 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20266 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20267 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20268 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20269 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20270 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20271 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20272 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20273 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20274 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20275 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20276 (gdb)
20277 @end smallexample
20278
20279
20280 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20281 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20282
20283 @subsubheading Synopsis
20284
20285 @smallexample
20286 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20287 @end smallexample
20288
20289 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20290 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20291 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20292
20293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20294
20295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20296 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20297 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20298
20299 @subsubheading Example
20300
20301 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20302 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20303 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20304 output.
20305
20306 @smallexample
20307 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20308 211^done,value="1"
20309 (gdb)
20310 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20311 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20312 (gdb)
20313 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20314 411^done,value="4"
20315 (gdb)
20316 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20317 511^done,value="4"
20318 (gdb)
20319 @end smallexample
20320
20321
20322 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20323 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20324
20325 @subsubheading Synopsis
20326
20327 @smallexample
20328 -data-list-changed-registers
20329 @end smallexample
20330
20331 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20332
20333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20334
20335 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20336 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20337
20338 @subsubheading Example
20339
20340 On a PPC MBX board:
20341
20342 @smallexample
20343 (gdb)
20344 -exec-continue
20345 ^running
20346
20347 (gdb)
20348 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20349 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20350 (gdb)
20351 -data-list-changed-registers
20352 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20353 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20354 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20355 (gdb)
20356 @end smallexample
20357
20358
20359 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20360 @findex -data-list-register-names
20361
20362 @subsubheading Synopsis
20363
20364 @smallexample
20365 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20366 @end smallexample
20367
20368 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20369 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20370 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20371 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20372 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20373 include empty register names.
20374
20375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20376
20377 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20378 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20379 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20380
20381 @subsubheading Example
20382
20383 For the PPC MBX board:
20384 @smallexample
20385 (gdb)
20386 -data-list-register-names
20387 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20388 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20389 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20390 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20391 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20392 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20393 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20394 (gdb)
20395 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20396 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20397 (gdb)
20398 @end smallexample
20399
20400 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20401 @findex -data-list-register-values
20402
20403 @subsubheading Synopsis
20404
20405 @smallexample
20406 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20407 @end smallexample
20408
20409 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20410 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20411 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20412 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20413
20414 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20415
20416 @table @code
20417 @item x
20418 Hexadecimal
20419 @item o
20420 Octal
20421 @item t
20422 Binary
20423 @item d
20424 Decimal
20425 @item r
20426 Raw
20427 @item N
20428 Natural
20429 @end table
20430
20431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20432
20433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20434 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20435
20436 @subsubheading Example
20437
20438 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20439 don't appear in the actual output):
20440
20441 @smallexample
20442 (gdb)
20443 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20444 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20445 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20446 (gdb)
20447 -data-list-register-values x
20448 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20449 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20450 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20451 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20452 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20453 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20454 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20455 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20456 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20457 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20458 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20459 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20460 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20461 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20462 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20463 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20464 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20465 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20466 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20467 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20468 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20469 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20470 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20471 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20472 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20473 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20474 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20475 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20476 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20477 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20478 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20479 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20480 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20481 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20482 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20483 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20484 (gdb)
20485 @end smallexample
20486
20487
20488 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20489 @findex -data-read-memory
20490
20491 @subsubheading Synopsis
20492
20493 @smallexample
20494 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20495 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20496 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20497 @end smallexample
20498
20499 @noindent
20500 where:
20501
20502 @table @samp
20503 @item @var{address}
20504 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20505 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20506 quoted using the C convention.
20507
20508 @item @var{word-format}
20509 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20510 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20511 ,Output Formats}).
20512
20513 @item @var{word-size}
20514 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20515
20516 @item @var{nr-rows}
20517 The number of rows in the output table.
20518
20519 @item @var{nr-cols}
20520 The number of columns in the output table.
20521
20522 @item @var{aschar}
20523 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20524 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20525 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20526 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20527
20528 @item @var{byte-offset}
20529 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20530 @end table
20531
20532 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20533 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20534 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20535 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20536 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20537 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20538 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20539 @samp{addr}.
20540
20541 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20542 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20543 @samp{prev-page}.
20544
20545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20546
20547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20548 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20549
20550 @subsubheading Example
20551
20552 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20553 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20554 word. Display each word in hex.
20555
20556 @smallexample
20557 (gdb)
20558 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20559 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20560 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20561 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20562 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20563 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20564 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20565 (gdb)
20566 @end smallexample
20567
20568 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20569 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20570
20571 @smallexample
20572 (gdb)
20573 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20574 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20575 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20576 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20577 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20578 (gdb)
20579 @end smallexample
20580
20581 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20582 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20583 used as the non-printable character.
20584
20585 @smallexample
20586 (gdb)
20587 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20588 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20589 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20590 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20591 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20592 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20593 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20594 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20595 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20596 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20597 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20598 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20599 (gdb)
20600 @end smallexample
20601
20602 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20603 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20604 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20605
20606 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20607
20608 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20609
20610 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20611
20612 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20613
20614 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20615
20616 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20617
20618 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20619
20620 @c @subheading -trace-find
20621
20622 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20623
20624 @c @subheading -trace-info
20625
20626 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20627
20628 @c @subheading -trace-list
20629
20630 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20631
20632 @c @subheading -trace-save
20633
20634 @c @subheading -trace-start
20635
20636 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20637
20638
20639 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20640 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20641 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20642
20643
20644 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20645 @findex -symbol-info-address
20646
20647 @subsubheading Synopsis
20648
20649 @smallexample
20650 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20651 @end smallexample
20652
20653 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20654
20655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20656
20657 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20658
20659 @subsubheading Example
20660 N.A.
20661
20662
20663 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20664 @findex -symbol-info-file
20665
20666 @subsubheading Synopsis
20667
20668 @smallexample
20669 -symbol-info-file
20670 @end smallexample
20671
20672 Show the file for the symbol.
20673
20674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20675
20676 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20677 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20678
20679 @subsubheading Example
20680 N.A.
20681
20682
20683 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20684 @findex -symbol-info-function
20685
20686 @subsubheading Synopsis
20687
20688 @smallexample
20689 -symbol-info-function
20690 @end smallexample
20691
20692 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20693
20694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20695
20696 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20697
20698 @subsubheading Example
20699 N.A.
20700
20701
20702 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20703 @findex -symbol-info-line
20704
20705 @subsubheading Synopsis
20706
20707 @smallexample
20708 -symbol-info-line
20709 @end smallexample
20710
20711 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20712
20713 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20714
20715 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20716 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20717
20718 @subsubheading Example
20719 N.A.
20720
20721
20722 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20723 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20724
20725 @subsubheading Synopsis
20726
20727 @smallexample
20728 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20729 @end smallexample
20730
20731 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20732
20733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20734
20735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20736
20737 @subsubheading Example
20738 N.A.
20739
20740
20741 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20742 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20743
20744 @subsubheading Synopsis
20745
20746 @smallexample
20747 -symbol-list-functions
20748 @end smallexample
20749
20750 List the functions in the executable.
20751
20752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20753
20754 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20755 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20756
20757 @subsubheading Example
20758 N.A.
20759
20760
20761 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20762 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20763
20764 @subsubheading Synopsis
20765
20766 @smallexample
20767 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20768 @end smallexample
20769
20770 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20771 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20772 ascending PC order.
20773
20774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20775
20776 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20777
20778 @subsubheading Example
20779 @smallexample
20780 (gdb)
20781 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20782 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20783 (gdb)
20784 @end smallexample
20785
20786
20787 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20788 @findex -symbol-list-types
20789
20790 @subsubheading Synopsis
20791
20792 @smallexample
20793 -symbol-list-types
20794 @end smallexample
20795
20796 List all the type names.
20797
20798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20799
20800 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20801 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20802
20803 @subsubheading Example
20804 N.A.
20805
20806
20807 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20808 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20809
20810 @subsubheading Synopsis
20811
20812 @smallexample
20813 -symbol-list-variables
20814 @end smallexample
20815
20816 List all the global and static variable names.
20817
20818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20819
20820 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20821
20822 @subsubheading Example
20823 N.A.
20824
20825
20826 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20827 @findex -symbol-locate
20828
20829 @subsubheading Synopsis
20830
20831 @smallexample
20832 -symbol-locate
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20836
20837 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20838
20839 @subsubheading Example
20840 N.A.
20841
20842
20843 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20844 @findex -symbol-type
20845
20846 @subsubheading Synopsis
20847
20848 @smallexample
20849 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20850 @end smallexample
20851
20852 Show type of @var{variable}.
20853
20854 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20855
20856 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20857 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20858
20859 @subsubheading Example
20860 N.A.
20861
20862
20863 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20864 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20865 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20866
20867 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20868 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20869
20870 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20871 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20872
20873 @subsubheading Synopsis
20874
20875 @smallexample
20876 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20877 @end smallexample
20878
20879 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20880 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20881 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20882 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20883 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20884 notification.
20885
20886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20887
20888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20889
20890 @subsubheading Example
20891
20892 @smallexample
20893 (gdb)
20894 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20895 ^done
20896 (gdb)
20897 @end smallexample
20898
20899
20900 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20901 @findex -file-exec-file
20902
20903 @subsubheading Synopsis
20904
20905 @smallexample
20906 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20907 @end smallexample
20908
20909 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20910 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20911 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20912 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20913 notification.
20914
20915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20916
20917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20918
20919 @subsubheading Example
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 (gdb)
20923 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20924 ^done
20925 (gdb)
20926 @end smallexample
20927
20928
20929 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20930 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20931
20932 @subsubheading Synopsis
20933
20934 @smallexample
20935 -file-list-exec-sections
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 List the sections of the current executable file.
20939
20940 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20941
20942 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20943 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20944 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20945
20946 @subsubheading Example
20947 N.A.
20948
20949
20950 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20951 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20952
20953 @subsubheading Synopsis
20954
20955 @smallexample
20956 -file-list-exec-source-file
20957 @end smallexample
20958
20959 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20960 to the current source file for the current executable.
20961
20962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20963
20964 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20965
20966 @subsubheading Example
20967
20968 @smallexample
20969 (gdb)
20970 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20971 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20972 (gdb)
20973 @end smallexample
20974
20975
20976 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20977 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20978
20979 @subsubheading Synopsis
20980
20981 @smallexample
20982 -file-list-exec-source-files
20983 @end smallexample
20984
20985 List the source files for the current executable.
20986
20987 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20988 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20989
20990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20991
20992 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20993 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20994
20995 @subsubheading Example
20996 @smallexample
20997 (gdb)
20998 -file-list-exec-source-files
20999 ^done,files=[
21000 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21001 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21002 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21003 (gdb)
21004 @end smallexample
21005
21006 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21007 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21008
21009 @subsubheading Synopsis
21010
21011 @smallexample
21012 -file-list-shared-libraries
21013 @end smallexample
21014
21015 List the shared libraries in the program.
21016
21017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21018
21019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21020
21021 @subsubheading Example
21022 N.A.
21023
21024
21025 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21026 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21027
21028 @subsubheading Synopsis
21029
21030 @smallexample
21031 -file-list-symbol-files
21032 @end smallexample
21033
21034 List symbol files.
21035
21036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21037
21038 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21039
21040 @subsubheading Example
21041 N.A.
21042
21043
21044 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21045 @findex -file-symbol-file
21046
21047 @subsubheading Synopsis
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21054 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21055 produced, except for a completion notification.
21056
21057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21058
21059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21060
21061 @subsubheading Example
21062
21063 @smallexample
21064 (gdb)
21065 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21066 ^done
21067 (gdb)
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070 @ignore
21071 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21072 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21073 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21074
21075 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21076
21077 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21078
21079 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21080
21081 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21082
21083 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21084
21085 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21086
21087 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21088
21089 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21090
21091 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21092 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21093 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21094
21095 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21096
21097 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21098
21099 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21100
21101 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21102 @end ignore
21103
21104
21105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21106 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21108
21109
21110 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21111 @findex -target-attach
21112
21113 @subsubheading Synopsis
21114
21115 @smallexample
21116 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21117 @end smallexample
21118
21119 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21120
21121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21122
21123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21124
21125 @subsubheading Example
21126 N.A.
21127
21128
21129 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21130 @findex -target-compare-sections
21131
21132 @subsubheading Synopsis
21133
21134 @smallexample
21135 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21136 @end smallexample
21137
21138 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21139 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21140
21141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21142
21143 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21144
21145 @subsubheading Example
21146 N.A.
21147
21148
21149 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21150 @findex -target-detach
21151
21152 @subsubheading Synopsis
21153
21154 @smallexample
21155 -target-detach
21156 @end smallexample
21157
21158 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21159 There's no output.
21160
21161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21162
21163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21164
21165 @subsubheading Example
21166
21167 @smallexample
21168 (gdb)
21169 -target-detach
21170 ^done
21171 (gdb)
21172 @end smallexample
21173
21174
21175 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21176 @findex -target-disconnect
21177
21178 @subsubheading Synopsis
21179
21180 @smallexample
21181 -target-disconnect
21182 @end smallexample
21183
21184 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21185 generally not resumed.
21186
21187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21188
21189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21190
21191 @subsubheading Example
21192
21193 @smallexample
21194 (gdb)
21195 -target-disconnect
21196 ^done
21197 (gdb)
21198 @end smallexample
21199
21200
21201 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21202 @findex -target-download
21203
21204 @subsubheading Synopsis
21205
21206 @smallexample
21207 -target-download
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21211 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21212
21213 @table @samp
21214 @item section
21215 The name of the section.
21216 @item section-sent
21217 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21218 @item section-size
21219 The size of the section.
21220 @item total-sent
21221 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21222 @item total-size
21223 The size of the overall executable to download.
21224 @end table
21225
21226 @noindent
21227 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21228 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21229
21230 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21231 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21232
21233 @table @samp
21234 @item section
21235 The name of the section.
21236 @item section-size
21237 The size of the section.
21238 @item total-size
21239 The size of the overall executable to download.
21240 @end table
21241
21242 @noindent
21243 At the end, a summary is printed.
21244
21245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21246
21247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21248
21249 @subsubheading Example
21250
21251 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21252 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21253
21254 @smallexample
21255 (gdb)
21256 -target-download
21257 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21258 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21259 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21260 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21261 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21262 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21263 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21264 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21265 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21266 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21267 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21268 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21269 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21270 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21271 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21272 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21273 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21274 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21275 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21276 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21277 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21278 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21279 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21280 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21281 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21282 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21283 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21284 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21285 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21286 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21287 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21288 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21289 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21290 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21291 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21292 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21293 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21294 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21295 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21296 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21297 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21298 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21299 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21300 write-rate="429"
21301 (gdb)
21302 @end smallexample
21303
21304
21305 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21306 @findex -target-exec-status
21307
21308 @subsubheading Synopsis
21309
21310 @smallexample
21311 -target-exec-status
21312 @end smallexample
21313
21314 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21315 not, for instance).
21316
21317 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21318
21319 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21320
21321 @subsubheading Example
21322 N.A.
21323
21324
21325 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21326 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21327
21328 @subsubheading Synopsis
21329
21330 @smallexample
21331 -target-list-available-targets
21332 @end smallexample
21333
21334 List the possible targets to connect to.
21335
21336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21337
21338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21339
21340 @subsubheading Example
21341 N.A.
21342
21343
21344 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21345 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21346
21347 @subsubheading Synopsis
21348
21349 @smallexample
21350 -target-list-current-targets
21351 @end smallexample
21352
21353 Describe the current target.
21354
21355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21356
21357 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21358 other things).
21359
21360 @subsubheading Example
21361 N.A.
21362
21363
21364 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21365 @findex -target-list-parameters
21366
21367 @subsubheading Synopsis
21368
21369 @smallexample
21370 -target-list-parameters
21371 @end smallexample
21372
21373 @c ????
21374
21375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21376
21377 No equivalent.
21378
21379 @subsubheading Example
21380 N.A.
21381
21382
21383 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21384 @findex -target-select
21385
21386 @subsubheading Synopsis
21387
21388 @smallexample
21389 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21390 @end smallexample
21391
21392 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21393
21394 @table @samp
21395 @item @var{type}
21396 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21397 @item @var{parameters}
21398 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21399 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21400 @end table
21401
21402 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21403 which the target program is, in the following form:
21404
21405 @smallexample
21406 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21407 args=[@var{arg list}]
21408 @end smallexample
21409
21410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21411
21412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21413
21414 @subsubheading Example
21415
21416 @smallexample
21417 (gdb)
21418 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21419 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21420 (gdb)
21421 @end smallexample
21422
21423 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21424 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21425 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21426
21427
21428 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21429 @findex -target-file-put
21430
21431 @subsubheading Synopsis
21432
21433 @smallexample
21434 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21435 @end smallexample
21436
21437 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21438 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21439
21440 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21441
21442 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21443
21444 @subsubheading Example
21445
21446 @smallexample
21447 (gdb)
21448 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21449 ^done
21450 (gdb)
21451 @end smallexample
21452
21453
21454 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21455 @findex -target-file-get
21456
21457 @subsubheading Synopsis
21458
21459 @smallexample
21460 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21461 @end smallexample
21462
21463 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21464 on the host system.
21465
21466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21467
21468 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21469
21470 @subsubheading Example
21471
21472 @smallexample
21473 (gdb)
21474 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21475 ^done
21476 (gdb)
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479
21480 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21481 @findex -target-file-delete
21482
21483 @subsubheading Synopsis
21484
21485 @smallexample
21486 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21487 @end smallexample
21488
21489 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21490
21491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21492
21493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21494
21495 @subsubheading Example
21496
21497 @smallexample
21498 (gdb)
21499 -target-file-delete remotefile
21500 ^done
21501 (gdb)
21502 @end smallexample
21503
21504
21505 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21506 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21507 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21508
21509 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21510
21511 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21512 @findex -gdb-exit
21513
21514 @subsubheading Synopsis
21515
21516 @smallexample
21517 -gdb-exit
21518 @end smallexample
21519
21520 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21521
21522 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21523
21524 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21525
21526 @subsubheading Example
21527
21528 @smallexample
21529 (gdb)
21530 -gdb-exit
21531 ^exit
21532 @end smallexample
21533
21534
21535 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21536 @findex -exec-abort
21537
21538 @subsubheading Synopsis
21539
21540 @smallexample
21541 -exec-abort
21542 @end smallexample
21543
21544 Kill the inferior running program.
21545
21546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21547
21548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21549
21550 @subsubheading Example
21551 N.A.
21552
21553
21554 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21555 @findex -gdb-set
21556
21557 @subsubheading Synopsis
21558
21559 @smallexample
21560 -gdb-set
21561 @end smallexample
21562
21563 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21564 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21565
21566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21567
21568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21569
21570 @subsubheading Example
21571
21572 @smallexample
21573 (gdb)
21574 -gdb-set $foo=3
21575 ^done
21576 (gdb)
21577 @end smallexample
21578
21579
21580 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21581 @findex -gdb-show
21582
21583 @subsubheading Synopsis
21584
21585 @smallexample
21586 -gdb-show
21587 @end smallexample
21588
21589 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21590
21591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21592
21593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21594
21595 @subsubheading Example
21596
21597 @smallexample
21598 (gdb)
21599 -gdb-show annotate
21600 ^done,value="0"
21601 (gdb)
21602 @end smallexample
21603
21604 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21605
21606
21607 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21608 @findex -gdb-version
21609
21610 @subsubheading Synopsis
21611
21612 @smallexample
21613 -gdb-version
21614 @end smallexample
21615
21616 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21617
21618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21619
21620 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21621 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21622
21623 @subsubheading Example
21624
21625 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21626 @c box in TeX.
21627 @smallexample
21628 (gdb)
21629 -gdb-version
21630 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21631 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21632 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21633 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21634 ~ certain conditions.
21635 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21636 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21637 ~ details.
21638 ~This GDB was configured as
21639 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21640 ^done
21641 (gdb)
21642 @end smallexample
21643
21644 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21645 @findex -list-features
21646
21647 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21648 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21649 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21650 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21651 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21652 startup.
21653
21654 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21655 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21656 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21657 is given below.
21658
21659 Example output:
21660
21661 @smallexample
21662 (gdb) -list-features
21663 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21664 @end smallexample
21665
21666 The current list of features is:
21667
21668 @itemize @minus
21669 @item
21670 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21671 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21672 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21673 @item
21674 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21675 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21676
21677 @end itemize
21678
21679 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21680 @findex -interpreter-exec
21681
21682 @subheading Synopsis
21683
21684 @smallexample
21685 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21686 @end smallexample
21687 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21688
21689 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21690
21691 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21692
21693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21694
21695 @subheading Example
21696
21697 @smallexample
21698 (gdb)
21699 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21700 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21701 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21702 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21703 ^done
21704 (gdb)
21705 @end smallexample
21706
21707 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21708 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21709
21710 @subheading Synopsis
21711
21712 @smallexample
21713 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21714 @end smallexample
21715
21716 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21717
21718 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21719
21720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21721
21722 @subheading Example
21723
21724 @smallexample
21725 (gdb)
21726 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21727 ^done
21728 (gdb)
21729 @end smallexample
21730
21731 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21732 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21733
21734 @subheading Synopsis
21735
21736 @smallexample
21737 -inferior-tty-show
21738 @end smallexample
21739
21740 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21741
21742 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21743
21744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21745
21746 @subheading Example
21747
21748 @smallexample
21749 (gdb)
21750 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21751 ^done
21752 (gdb)
21753 -inferior-tty-show
21754 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21755 (gdb)
21756 @end smallexample
21757
21758 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21759 @findex -enable-timings
21760
21761 @subheading Synopsis
21762
21763 @smallexample
21764 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21765 @end smallexample
21766
21767 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21768 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21769 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21770 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21771
21772 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21773
21774 No equivalent.
21775
21776 @subheading Example
21777
21778 @smallexample
21779 (gdb)
21780 -enable-timings
21781 ^done
21782 (gdb)
21783 -break-insert main
21784 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21785 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21786 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21787 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21788 (gdb)
21789 -enable-timings no
21790 ^done
21791 (gdb)
21792 -exec-run
21793 ^running
21794 (gdb)
21795 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21796 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21797 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21798 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21799 (gdb)
21800 @end smallexample
21801
21802 @node Annotations
21803 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21804
21805 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21806 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21807 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21808 relatively high level.
21809
21810 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21811 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21812
21813 @ignore
21814 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21815 @end ignore
21816
21817 @menu
21818 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21819 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21820 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21821 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21822 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21823 * Annotations for Running::
21824 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21825 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21826 @end menu
21827
21828 @node Annotations Overview
21829 @section What is an Annotation?
21830 @cindex annotations
21831
21832 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21833 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21834 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21835 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21836 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21837 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21838 cannot contain newline characters.
21839
21840 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21841 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21842 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21843 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21844 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21845 means those three characters as output.
21846
21847 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21848 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21849 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21850 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21851 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21852 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21853 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21854 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21855 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21856
21857 @table @code
21858 @kindex set annotate
21859 @item set annotate @var{level}
21860 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21861 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21862
21863 @item show annotate
21864 @kindex show annotate
21865 Show the current annotation level.
21866 @end table
21867
21868 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21869
21870 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21874 GNU gdb 6.0
21875 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21876 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21877 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21878 under certain conditions.
21879 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21880 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21881 for details.
21882 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21883
21884 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21885 (@value{GDBP})
21886 ^Z^Zprompt
21887 @kbd{quit}
21888
21889 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21890 $
21891 @end smallexample
21892
21893 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21894 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21895 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21896 output from @value{GDBN}.
21897
21898 @node Server Prefix
21899 @section The Server Prefix
21900 @cindex server prefix
21901
21902 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21903 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21904 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21905 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21906 a transparent manner.
21907
21908 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21909 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21910 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21911
21912 @node Prompting
21913 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21914
21915 @cindex annotations for prompts
21916 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21917 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21918 over, etc.
21919
21920 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21921 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21922 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21923 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21924 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21925 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21926 features the following annotations:
21927
21928 @smallexample
21929 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21930 ^Z^Zprompt
21931 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21932 @end smallexample
21933
21934 The input types are
21935
21936 @table @code
21937 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21938 @findex prompt annotation
21939 @findex post-prompt annotation
21940 @item prompt
21941 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21942
21943 @findex pre-commands annotation
21944 @findex commands annotation
21945 @findex post-commands annotation
21946 @item commands
21947 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21948 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21949
21950 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21951 @findex overload-choice annotation
21952 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21953 @item overload-choice
21954 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21955
21956 @findex pre-query annotation
21957 @findex query annotation
21958 @findex post-query annotation
21959 @item query
21960 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21961
21962 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21963 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21964 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21965 @item prompt-for-continue
21966 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21967 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21968 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21969 presence of annotations.
21970 @end table
21971
21972 @node Errors
21973 @section Errors
21974 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21975
21976 @findex quit annotation
21977 @smallexample
21978 ^Z^Zquit
21979 @end smallexample
21980
21981 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21982
21983 @findex error annotation
21984 @smallexample
21985 ^Z^Zerror
21986 @end smallexample
21987
21988 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21989
21990 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21991 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21992 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21993 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21994 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21995 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21996 to the top level.
21997
21998 @findex error-begin annotation
21999 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22000
22001 @smallexample
22002 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22003 @end smallexample
22004
22005 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22006 message.
22007
22008 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22009 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22010 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22011
22012 @node Invalidation
22013 @section Invalidation Notices
22014
22015 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22016 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22017 changed.
22018
22019 @table @code
22020 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22021 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22022
22023 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22024 have changed.
22025
22026 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22027 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22028
22029 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22030 deleted a breakpoint.
22031 @end table
22032
22033 @node Annotations for Running
22034 @section Running the Program
22035 @cindex annotations for running programs
22036
22037 @findex starting annotation
22038 @findex stopping annotation
22039 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22040 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22041
22042 @smallexample
22043 ^Z^Zstarting
22044 @end smallexample
22045
22046 is output. When the program stops,
22047
22048 @smallexample
22049 ^Z^Zstopped
22050 @end smallexample
22051
22052 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22053 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22054
22055 @table @code
22056 @findex exited annotation
22057 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22058 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22059 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22060
22061 @findex signalled annotation
22062 @findex signal-name annotation
22063 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22064 @findex signal-string annotation
22065 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22066 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22067 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22068 annotation continues:
22069
22070 @smallexample
22071 @var{intro-text}
22072 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22073 @var{name}
22074 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22075 @var{middle-text}
22076 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22077 @var{string}
22078 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22079 @var{end-text}
22080 @end smallexample
22081
22082 @noindent
22083 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22084 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22085 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22086 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22087 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22088
22089 @findex signal annotation
22090 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22091 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22092 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22093 terminated with it.
22094
22095 @findex breakpoint annotation
22096 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22097 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22098
22099 @findex watchpoint annotation
22100 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22101 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22102 @end table
22103
22104 @node Source Annotations
22105 @section Displaying Source
22106 @cindex annotations for source display
22107
22108 @findex source annotation
22109 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22110
22111 @smallexample
22112 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22113 @end smallexample
22114
22115 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22116 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22117 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22118 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22119 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22120 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22121 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22122 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22123 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22124 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22125 depend on the language).
22126
22127 @node GDB Bugs
22128 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22129 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22130 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22131
22132 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22133
22134 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22135 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22136 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22137 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22138
22139 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22140 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22141
22142 @menu
22143 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22144 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22145 @end menu
22146
22147 @node Bug Criteria
22148 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22149 @cindex bug criteria
22150
22151 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22152
22153 @itemize @bullet
22154 @cindex fatal signal
22155 @cindex debugger crash
22156 @cindex crash of debugger
22157 @item
22158 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22159 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22160
22161 @cindex error on valid input
22162 @item
22163 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22164 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22165 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22166
22167 @cindex invalid input
22168 @item
22169 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22170 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22171 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22172 for traditional practice''.
22173
22174 @item
22175 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22176 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22177 @end itemize
22178
22179 @node Bug Reporting
22180 @section How to Report Bugs
22181 @cindex bug reports
22182 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22183
22184 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22185 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22186 contact that organization first.
22187
22188 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22189 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22190 distribution.
22191 @c should add a web page ref...
22192
22193 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22194 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22195 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22196 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22197 be used.
22198
22199 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22200 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22201 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22202 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22203
22204 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22205 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22206 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22207 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22208 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22209 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22210 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22211 bug reports to the mailing list.
22212
22213 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22214 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22215 fact or leave it out, state it!
22216
22217 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22218 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22219 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22220 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22221 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22222 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22223 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22224 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22225 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22226
22227 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22228 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22229 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22230 self-contained.
22231
22232 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22233 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22234 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22235 bugs properly.
22236
22237 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22238
22239 @itemize @bullet
22240 @item
22241 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22242 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22243 version}.
22244
22245 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22246 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22247
22248 @item
22249 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22250 version number.
22251
22252 @item
22253 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22254 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22255
22256 @item
22257 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22258 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22259 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22260 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22261 those compilers.
22262
22263 @item
22264 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22265 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22266 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22267 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22268
22269 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22270 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22271
22272 @item
22273 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22274 reproduce the bug.
22275
22276 @item
22277 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22278 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22279
22280 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22281 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22282 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22283 a chance to make a mistake.
22284
22285 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22286 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22287 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22288 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22289 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22290 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22291 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22292 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22293
22294 @pindex script
22295 @cindex recording a session script
22296 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22297 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22298 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22299 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22300
22301 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22302 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22303
22304 @item
22305 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22306 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22307 it by context, not by line number.
22308
22309 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22310 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22311
22312 @end itemize
22313
22314 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22315
22316 @itemize @bullet
22317 @item
22318 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22319
22320 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22321 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22322 changes will not affect it.
22323
22324 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22325 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22326 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22327 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22328
22329 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22330 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22331 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22332 less time, and so on.
22333
22334 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22335 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22336
22337 @item
22338 A patch for the bug.
22339
22340 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22341 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22342 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22343 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22344
22345 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22346 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22347 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22348 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22349
22350 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22351 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22352 help us to understand.
22353
22354 @item
22355 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22356
22357 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22358 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22359 @end itemize
22360
22361 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22362 @c and consists of the two following files:
22363 @c rluser.texinfo
22364 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22365 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22366 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22367 @include rluser.texi
22368 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22369
22370
22371 @node Formatting Documentation
22372 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22373
22374 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22375 @cindex reference card
22376 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22377 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22378 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22379 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22380 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22381 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22382
22383 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22384 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22385
22386 @smallexample
22387 make refcard.dvi
22388 @end smallexample
22389
22390 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22391 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22392 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22393 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22394 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22395
22396 @cindex documentation
22397
22398 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22399 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22400 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22401 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22402 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22403 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22404
22405 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22406 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22407 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22408 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22409 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22410 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22411 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22412 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22413
22414 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22415 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22416 @code{makeinfo}.
22417
22418 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22419 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22420 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22421
22422 @smallexample
22423 cd gdb
22424 make gdb.info
22425 @end smallexample
22426
22427 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22428 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22429 Texinfo definitions file.
22430
22431 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22432 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22433 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22434 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22435 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22436 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22437 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22438
22439 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22440 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22441 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22442 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22443 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22444 directory.
22445
22446 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22447 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22448 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22449 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22450
22451 @smallexample
22452 make gdb.dvi
22453 @end smallexample
22454
22455 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22456
22457 @node Installing GDB
22458 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22459 @cindex installation
22460
22461 @menu
22462 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22463 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22464 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22465 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22466 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22467 @end menu
22468
22469 @node Requirements
22470 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22471 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22472
22473 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22474 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22475
22476 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22477 @table @asis
22478 @item ISO C90 compiler
22479 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22480 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22481
22482 @end table
22483
22484 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22485 @table @asis
22486 @item Expat
22487 @anchor{Expat}
22488 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22489 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22490 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22491 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22492 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22493 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22494
22495 Expat is used for:
22496
22497 @itemize @bullet
22498 @item
22499 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22500 @item
22501 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22502 @item
22503 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22504 @item
22505 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22506 @end itemize
22507
22508 @end table
22509
22510 @node Running Configure
22511 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22512 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22513 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22514 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22515 build the @code{gdb} program.
22516 @iftex
22517 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22518 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22519 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22520 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22521 @end iftex
22522
22523 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22524 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22525 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22526
22527 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22528 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22529
22530 @table @code
22531 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22532 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22533
22534 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22535 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22536
22537 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22538 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22539
22540 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22541 @sc{gnu} include files
22542
22543 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22544 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22545
22546 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22547 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22548
22549 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22550 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22551
22552 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22553 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22554
22555 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22556 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22557 @end table
22558
22559 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22560 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22561 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22562
22563 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22564 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22565 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22566 argument.
22567
22568 For example:
22569
22570 @smallexample
22571 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22572 ./configure @var{host}
22573 make
22574 @end smallexample
22575
22576 @noindent
22577 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22578 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22579 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22580 correct value by examining your system.)
22581
22582 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22583 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22584 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22585 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22586
22587 @need 750
22588 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22589 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22590 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22591
22592 @smallexample
22593 sh configure @var{host}
22594 @end smallexample
22595
22596 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22597 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22598 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22599 @file{configure}
22600 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22601 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22602
22603 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22604 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22605 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22606 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22607 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22608 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22609 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22610 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22611 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22612
22613 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22614 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22615 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22616 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22617 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22618
22619 @node Separate Objdir
22620 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22621
22622 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22623 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22624 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22625 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22626 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22627 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22628 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22629 program specified there.
22630
22631 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22632 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22633 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22634 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22635 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22636 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22637
22638 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22639 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22640
22641 @smallexample
22642 @group
22643 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22644 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22645 cd ../gdb-sun4
22646 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22647 make
22648 @end group
22649 @end smallexample
22650
22651 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22652 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22653 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22654 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22655 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22656 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22657
22658 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22659 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22660 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22661 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22662 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22663
22664 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22665 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22666 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22667 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22668 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22669 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22670
22671 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22672 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22673 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22674
22675 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22676 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22677 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22678 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22679 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22680
22681 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22682 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22683 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22684 with each other.
22685
22686 @node Config Names
22687 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22688
22689 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22690 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22691 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22692 of information in the following pattern:
22693
22694 @smallexample
22695 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22696 @end smallexample
22697
22698 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22699 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22700 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22701
22702 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22703 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22704 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22705 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22706 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22707 abbreviations---for example:
22708
22709 @smallexample
22710 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22711 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22712 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22713 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22714 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22715 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22716 % sh config.sub sun4
22717 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22718 % sh config.sub sun3
22719 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22720 % sh config.sub i986v
22721 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22722 @end smallexample
22723
22724 @noindent
22725 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22726 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22727
22728 @node Configure Options
22729 @section @file{configure} Options
22730
22731 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22732 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22733 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22734 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22735
22736 @smallexample
22737 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22738 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22739 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22740 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22741 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22742 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22743 @var{host}
22744 @end smallexample
22745
22746 @noindent
22747 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22748 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22749 @samp{--}.
22750
22751 @table @code
22752 @item --help
22753 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22754
22755 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22756 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22757 @file{@var{dir}}.
22758
22759 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22760 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22761 @file{@var{dir}}.
22762
22763 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22764 @need 2000
22765 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22766 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22767 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22768 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22769 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22770 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22771 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22772 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22773 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22774 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22775 @var{dirname}.
22776
22777 @item --norecursion
22778 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22779 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22780
22781 @item --target=@var{target}
22782 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22783 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22784 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22785
22786 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22787
22788 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22789 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22790
22791 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22792 @end table
22793
22794 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22795 needed for special purposes only.
22796
22797 @node Maintenance Commands
22798 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22799 @cindex maintenance commands
22800 @cindex internal commands
22801
22802 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22803 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22804 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22805 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22806 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22807
22808 @table @code
22809 @kindex maint agent
22810 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22811 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22812 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22813 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22814
22815 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22816 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22817 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22818 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22819 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22820 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22821 is shown:
22822
22823 @table @code
22824 @item breakpoint
22825 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22826
22827 @item watchpoint
22828 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22829
22830 @item longjmp
22831 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22832 @code{longjmp} calls.
22833
22834 @item longjmp resume
22835 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22836
22837 @item until
22838 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22839
22840 @item finish
22841 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22842
22843 @item shlib events
22844 Shared library events.
22845
22846 @end table
22847
22848 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22849 @item maint check-symtabs
22850 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22851
22852 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22853 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22854 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22855
22856 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22857 @item maint cplus namespace
22858 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22859
22860 @kindex maint demangle
22861 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22862 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22863
22864 @kindex maint deprecate
22865 @kindex maint undeprecate
22866 @cindex deprecated commands
22867 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22868 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22869 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22870 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22871 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22872 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22873 the replacement as part of the warning.
22874
22875 @kindex maint dump-me
22876 @item maint dump-me
22877 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22878 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22879 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22880 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22881
22882 @kindex maint internal-error
22883 @kindex maint internal-warning
22884 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22885 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22886 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22887 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22888 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22889 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22890 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22891 @value{GDBN} session.
22892
22893 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22894 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22895
22896 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22897
22898 @smallexample
22899 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22900 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22901 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22902 debugging may prove unreliable.
22903 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22904 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22905 (@value{GDBP})
22906 @end smallexample
22907
22908 @kindex maint packet
22909 @item maint packet @var{text}
22910 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22911 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22912 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22913 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22914 checksum.
22915
22916 @kindex maint print architecture
22917 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22918 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22919 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22920
22921 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
22922 @item maint print c-tdesc
22923 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
22924 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
22925 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
22926
22927 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22928 @item maint print dummy-frames
22929 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22930
22931 @smallexample
22932 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22933 @dots{}
22934 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22935 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22936 58 return (a + b);
22937 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22938 @dots{}
22939 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22940 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22941 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22942 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22943 (@value{GDBP})
22944 @end smallexample
22945
22946 Takes an optional file parameter.
22947
22948 @kindex maint print registers
22949 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22950 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22951 @kindex maint print register-groups
22952 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22953 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22954 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22955 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22956 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22957
22958 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22959 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22960 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22961 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22962 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22963 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22964
22965 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22966 write the information.
22967
22968 @kindex maint print reggroups
22969 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22970 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22971 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22972 information.
22973
22974 The register groups info looks like this:
22975
22976 @smallexample
22977 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22978 Group Type
22979 general user
22980 float user
22981 all user
22982 vector user
22983 system user
22984 save internal
22985 restore internal
22986 @end smallexample
22987
22988 @kindex flushregs
22989 @item flushregs
22990 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22991
22992 @kindex maint print objfiles
22993 @cindex info for known object files
22994 @item maint print objfiles
22995 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22996 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22997 and symtabs.
22998
22999 @kindex maint print statistics
23000 @cindex bcache statistics
23001 @item maint print statistics
23002 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23003 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23004 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23005 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23006 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23007 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23008 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23009 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23010 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23011 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23012 lengths.
23013
23014 @kindex maint print target-stack
23015 @cindex target stack description
23016 @item maint print target-stack
23017 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23018 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23019 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23020 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23021 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23022 address.
23023
23024 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23025 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23026
23027 @kindex maint print type
23028 @cindex type chain of a data type
23029 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23030 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23031 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23032 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23033 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23034 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23035
23036 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23037 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23038 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23039 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23040 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23041
23042 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23043 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23044 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23045 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23046 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23047 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23048 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23049 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23050 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23051
23052 @kindex maint set profile
23053 @kindex maint show profile
23054 @cindex profiling GDB
23055 @item maint set profile
23056 @itemx maint show profile
23057 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23058
23059 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23060 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23061 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23062 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23063 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23064 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23065 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23066
23067 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23068 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23069
23070 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23071 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23072 @item maint show-debug-regs
23073 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23074 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23075 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23076 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23077 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23078
23079 @kindex maint space
23080 @cindex memory used by commands
23081 @item maint space
23082 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23083 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23084 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23085 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23086 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23087
23088 @kindex maint time
23089 @cindex time of command execution
23090 @item maint time
23091 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23092 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23093 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23094 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23095 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23096
23097 @kindex maint translate-address
23098 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23099 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23100 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23101 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23102 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23103 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23104 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23105
23106 @end table
23107
23108 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23109 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23110
23111 @table @code
23112 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23113 @kindex set watchdog
23114 @cindex watchdog timer
23115 @cindex timeout for commands
23116 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23117 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23118 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23119
23120 @item show watchdog
23121 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23122 @end table
23123
23124 @node Remote Protocol
23125 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23126
23127 @menu
23128 * Overview::
23129 * Packets::
23130 * Stop Reply Packets::
23131 * General Query Packets::
23132 * Register Packet Format::
23133 * Tracepoint Packets::
23134 * Host I/O Packets::
23135 * Interrupts::
23136 * Examples::
23137 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23138 * Library List Format::
23139 * Memory Map Format::
23140 @end menu
23141
23142 @node Overview
23143 @section Overview
23144
23145 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23146 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23147 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23148 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23149
23150 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23151 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23152
23153 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23154 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23155 @cindex remote serial protocol
23156 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23157 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23158 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23159 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23160
23161 @smallexample
23162 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23163 @end smallexample
23164 @noindent
23165
23166 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23167 @noindent
23168 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23169 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23170 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23171
23172 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23173 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23174
23175 @smallexample
23176 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23177 @end smallexample
23178
23179 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23180 @noindent
23181 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23182 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23183 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23184
23185 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23186 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23187 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23188 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23189 retransmission):
23190
23191 @smallexample
23192 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23193 <- @code{+}
23194 @end smallexample
23195 @noindent
23196
23197 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23198 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23199 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23200 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23201
23202 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23203 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23204 exceptions).
23205
23206 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23207 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23208 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23209 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23210
23211 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23212 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23213 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23214
23215 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23216 @anchor{Binary Data}
23217 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23218 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23219 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23220 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23221 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23222 binary data.
23223
23224 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23225 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23226 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23227 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23228 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23229 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23230 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23231 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23232 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23233 (described next).
23234
23235 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23236 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23237 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23238 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23239 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23240 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23241 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23242 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23243 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23244 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23245 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23246 3}} more times.
23247
23248 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23249 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23250 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23251 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23252 @samp{0*"00}.
23253
23254 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23255 error number. That number is not well defined.
23256
23257 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23258 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23259 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23260 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23261 on that response.
23262
23263 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23264 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23265 optional.
23266
23267 @node Packets
23268 @section Packets
23269
23270 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23271 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23272 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23273 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23274
23275 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23276 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23277 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23278 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23279 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23280 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23281 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23282 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23283 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23284 @var{baz}.
23285
23286 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23287 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23288
23289 Here are the packet descriptions.
23290
23291 @table @samp
23292
23293 @item !
23294 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23295 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23296 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23297 debugged.
23298
23299 Reply:
23300 @table @samp
23301 @item OK
23302 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23303 @end table
23304
23305 @item ?
23306 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23307 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23308 step and continue.
23309
23310 Reply:
23311 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23312
23313 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23314 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23315 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23316 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23317 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23318
23319 Reply:
23320 @table @samp
23321 @item OK
23322 The arguments were set.
23323 @item E @var{NN}
23324 An error occurred.
23325 @end table
23326
23327 @item b @var{baud}
23328 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23329 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23330 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23331
23332 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23333 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23334 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23335
23336 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23337 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23338 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23339 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23340 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23341
23342 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23343 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23344 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23345 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23346
23347 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23348 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23349
23350 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23351 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23352 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23353 resume at current address.
23354
23355 Reply:
23356 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23357
23358 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23359 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23360 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23361 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23362
23363 Reply:
23364 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23365
23366 @item d
23367 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23368 Toggle debug flag.
23369
23370 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23371 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23372
23373 @item D
23374 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23375 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23376 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23377
23378 Reply:
23379 @table @samp
23380 @item OK
23381 for success
23382 @item E @var{NN}
23383 for an error
23384 @end table
23385
23386 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23387 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23388 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23389 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23390 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23391
23392 @item g
23393 @anchor{read registers packet}
23394 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23395 Read general registers.
23396
23397 Reply:
23398 @table @samp
23399 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23400 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23401 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23402 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23403 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23404 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23405 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23406 @item E @var{NN}
23407 for an error.
23408 @end table
23409
23410 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23411 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23412 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23413 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23414
23415 Reply:
23416 @table @samp
23417 @item OK
23418 for success
23419 @item E @var{NN}
23420 for an error
23421 @end table
23422
23423 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23424 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23425 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23426 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23427 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23428 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23429 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23430
23431 Reply:
23432 @table @samp
23433 @item OK
23434 for success
23435 @item E @var{NN}
23436 for an error
23437 @end table
23438
23439 @c FIXME: JTC:
23440 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23441 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23442 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23443 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23444 @c described. For example:
23445 @c
23446 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23447 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23448 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23449 @c
23450 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23451 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23452 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23453
23454 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23455 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23456 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23457 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23458 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23459 step starting at that address.
23460
23461 @item I
23462 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23463 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23464 step packet}.
23465
23466 @item k
23467 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23468 Kill request.
23469
23470 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23471 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23472 thread?)}.
23473
23474 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23475 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23476 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23477 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23478
23479 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23480 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23481 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23482 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23483 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23484 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23485 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23486 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23487
23488 Reply:
23489 @table @samp
23490 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23491 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23492 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23493 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23494 @item E @var{NN}
23495 @var{NN} is errno
23496 @end table
23497
23498 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23499 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23500 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23501 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23502 hexadecimal number.
23503
23504 Reply:
23505 @table @samp
23506 @item OK
23507 for success
23508 @item E @var{NN}
23509 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23510 written).
23511 @end table
23512
23513 @item p @var{n}
23514 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23515 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23516 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23517 register value is encoded.
23518
23519 Reply:
23520 @table @samp
23521 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23522 the register's value
23523 @item E @var{NN}
23524 for an error
23525 @item
23526 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23527 @end table
23528
23529 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23530 @anchor{write register packet}
23531 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23532 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23533 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23534 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23535
23536 Reply:
23537 @table @samp
23538 @item OK
23539 for success
23540 @item E @var{NN}
23541 for an error
23542 @end table
23543
23544 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23545 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23546 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23547 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23548 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23549 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23550
23551 @item r
23552 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23553 Reset the entire system.
23554
23555 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23556
23557 @item R @var{XX}
23558 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23559 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23560 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23561
23562 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23563
23564 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23565 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23566 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23567 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23568
23569 Reply:
23570 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23571
23572 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23573 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23574 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23575 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23576 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23577
23578 Reply:
23579 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23580
23581 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23582 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23583 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23584 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23585 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23586
23587 @item T @var{XX}
23588 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23589 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23590
23591 Reply:
23592 @table @samp
23593 @item OK
23594 thread is still alive
23595 @item E @var{NN}
23596 thread is dead
23597 @end table
23598
23599 @item v
23600 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23601 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23602
23603 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23604 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23605 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23606 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23607 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23608 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23609 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23610 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23611
23612 @table @samp
23613 @item c
23614 Continue.
23615 @item C @var{sig}
23616 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23617 @item s
23618 Step.
23619 @item S @var{sig}
23620 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23621 @end table
23622
23623 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23624 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23625
23626 Reply:
23627 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23628
23629 @item vCont?
23630 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23631 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23632
23633 Reply:
23634 @table @samp
23635 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23636 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23637 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23638 @item
23639 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23640 @end table
23641
23642 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23643 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23644 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23645 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23646
23647 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23648 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23649 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23650 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23651 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23652 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23653 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23654 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23655 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23656 packet is received.
23657
23658 Reply:
23659 @table @samp
23660 @item OK
23661 for success
23662 @item E @var{NN}
23663 for an error
23664 @end table
23665
23666 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23667 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23668 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23669 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23670 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23671 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23672 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23673 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23674 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23675 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23676 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23677 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23678
23679
23680 Reply:
23681 @table @samp
23682 @item OK
23683 for success
23684 @item E.memtype
23685 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23686 @item E @var{NN}
23687 for an error
23688 @end table
23689
23690 @item vFlashDone
23691 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23692 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23693 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23694 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23695 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23696 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23697 request is completed.
23698
23699 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23700 @anchor{X packet}
23701 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23702 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23703 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23704 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23705
23706 Reply:
23707 @table @samp
23708 @item OK
23709 for success
23710 @item E @var{NN}
23711 for an error
23712 @end table
23713
23714 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23715 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23716 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23717 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23718 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23719 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23720 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23721 @var{length} bytes.
23722
23723 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23724 separately.
23725
23726 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23727 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23728 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23729 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23730 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23731 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23732
23733 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23734 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23735 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23736 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23737 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23738 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23739
23740 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23741 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23742 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23743 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23744 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23745
23746 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23747 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23748 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23749 target, is not defined.}
23750
23751 Reply:
23752 @table @samp
23753 @item OK
23754 success
23755 @item
23756 not supported
23757 @item E @var{NN}
23758 for an error
23759 @end table
23760
23761 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23762 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23763 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23764 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23765 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23766 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23767
23768 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23769 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23770
23771 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23772 movement.}
23773
23774 Reply:
23775 @table @samp
23776 @item OK
23777 success
23778 @item
23779 not supported
23780 @item E @var{NN}
23781 for an error
23782 @end table
23783
23784 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23785 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23786 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23787 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23788 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23789
23790 Reply:
23791 @table @samp
23792 @item OK
23793 success
23794 @item
23795 not supported
23796 @item E @var{NN}
23797 for an error
23798 @end table
23799
23800 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23801 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23802 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23803 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23804 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23805
23806 Reply:
23807 @table @samp
23808 @item OK
23809 success
23810 @item
23811 not supported
23812 @item E @var{NN}
23813 for an error
23814 @end table
23815
23816 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23817 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23818 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23819 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23820 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23821
23822 Reply:
23823 @table @samp
23824 @item OK
23825 success
23826 @item
23827 not supported
23828 @item E @var{NN}
23829 for an error
23830 @end table
23831
23832 @end table
23833
23834 @node Stop Reply Packets
23835 @section Stop Reply Packets
23836 @cindex stop reply packets
23837
23838 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23839 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23840 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23841 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23842 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23843 @value{GDBN} source code.
23844
23845 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23846 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23847 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23848 components.
23849
23850 @table @samp
23851
23852 @item S @var{AA}
23853 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23854 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23855 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23856
23857 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23858 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23859 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23860 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23861 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23862 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23863 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23864 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23865
23866 @itemize @bullet
23867 @item
23868 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23869 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23870 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23871 two-digit hex number.
23872
23873 @item
23874 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23875 hex.
23876
23877 @item
23878 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23879 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23880 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23881 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23882
23883 @item
23884 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23885 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23886 future.
23887 @end itemize
23888
23889 The currently defined stop reasons are:
23890
23891 @table @samp
23892 @item watch
23893 @itemx rwatch
23894 @itemx awatch
23895 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23896 hex.
23897
23898 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
23899 @item library
23900 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23901 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23902 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23903 @end table
23904
23905 @item W @var{AA}
23906 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23907 applicable to certain targets.
23908
23909 @item X @var{AA}
23910 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23911
23912 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23913 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23914 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23915 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23916 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23917
23918 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23919 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23920 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23921 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23922 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23923 system calls.
23924
23925 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23926 this very system call.
23927
23928 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23929 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23930 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23931 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23932 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23933 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23934
23935 @end table
23936
23937 @node General Query Packets
23938 @section General Query Packets
23939 @cindex remote query requests
23940
23941 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23942 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23943 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23944 sending information to and from the stub.
23945
23946 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23947 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23948 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23949 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23950 conventions:
23951
23952 @itemize @bullet
23953 @item
23954 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23955 @item
23956 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23957 letter.
23958 @item
23959 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23960 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23961 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23962 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23963 @end itemize
23964
23965 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23966 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23967 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23968 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23969 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23970 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23971 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23972 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23973 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23974 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23975 packet.}.
23976
23977 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23978 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23979 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23980 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23981 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23982
23983 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23984
23985 @table @samp
23986
23987 @item qC
23988 @cindex current thread, remote request
23989 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23990 Return the current thread id.
23991
23992 Reply:
23993 @table @samp
23994 @item QC @var{pid}
23995 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23996 @item @r{(anything else)}
23997 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23998 @end table
23999
24000 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24001 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24002 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24003 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24004 Reply:
24005 @table @samp
24006 @item E @var{NN}
24007 An error (such as memory fault)
24008 @item C @var{crc32}
24009 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24010 @end table
24011
24012 @item qfThreadInfo
24013 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24014 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24015 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24016 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24017 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24018 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24019 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24020 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24021 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24022 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24023
24024 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24025
24026 Reply:
24027 @table @samp
24028 @item m @var{id}
24029 A single thread id
24030 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24031 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24032 @item l
24033 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24034 @end table
24035
24036 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24037 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24038 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24039 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24040 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24041
24042 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24043 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24044 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24045 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24046 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24047
24048 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24049 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24050
24051 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24052 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24053 information associated with the variable.)
24054
24055 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24056 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24057 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24058 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24059 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24060 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24061
24062 Reply:
24063 @table @samp
24064 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24065 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24066 local storage requested.
24067
24068 @item E @var{nn}
24069 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24070
24071 @item
24072 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24073 @end table
24074
24075 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24076 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24077 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24078 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24079 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24080 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24081 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24082
24083 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24084
24085 Reply:
24086 @table @samp
24087 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24088 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24089 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24090 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24091 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24092 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24093 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24094 @end table
24095
24096 @item qOffsets
24097 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24098 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24099 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24100 image.
24101
24102 Reply:
24103 @table @samp
24104 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24105 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24106 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24107 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24108 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24109 segments by the supplied offsets.
24110
24111 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24112 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24113 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24114
24115 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24116 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24117 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24118 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24119 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24120 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24121 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24122 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24123 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24124 @end table
24125
24126 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24127 @cindex thread information, remote request
24128 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24129 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24130 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24131
24132 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24133 (see below).
24134
24135 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24136
24137 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24138 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24139 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24140 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24141 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24142 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24143 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24144 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24145 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24146 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24147 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24148 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24149 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24150
24151 Reply:
24152 @table @samp
24153 @item OK
24154 The request succeeded.
24155
24156 @item E @var{nn}
24157 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24158
24159 @item
24160 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24161 the stub.
24162 @end table
24163
24164 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24165 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24166 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24167 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24168
24169 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24170 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24171 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24172 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24173 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24174 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24175 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24176 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24177 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24178
24179 Reply:
24180 @table @samp
24181 @item OK
24182 A command response with no output.
24183 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24184 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24185 @item E @var{NN}
24186 Indicate a badly formed request.
24187 @item
24188 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24189 @end table
24190
24191 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24192 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24193 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24194 packets.)
24195
24196 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24197 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24198 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24199 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24200 @anchor{qSupported}
24201 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24202 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24203 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24204 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24205 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24206 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24207 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24208 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24209 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24210 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24211 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24212 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24213 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24214 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24215
24216 Reply:
24217 @table @samp
24218 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24219 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24220 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24221 possible forms).
24222 @item
24223 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24224 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24225 @end table
24226
24227 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24228 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24229 are:
24230
24231 @table @samp
24232 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24233 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24234 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24235 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24236 @item @var{name}+
24237 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24238 need an associated value.
24239 @item @var{name}-
24240 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24241 @item @var{name}?
24242 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24243 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24244 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24245 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24246 @end table
24247
24248 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24249 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24250 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24251 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24252 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24253
24254 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24255 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24256 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24257 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24258 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24259 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24260 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24261 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24262 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24263 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24264 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24265 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24266 all the features it supports.
24267
24268 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24269 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24270
24271 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24272 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24273 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24274 form response.
24275
24276 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24277 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24278 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24279 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24280
24281 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24282 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24283 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24284 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24285 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24286
24287 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24288
24289 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24290 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24291 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24292 @item Feature Name
24293 @tab Value Required
24294 @tab Default
24295 @tab Probe Allowed
24296
24297 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24298 @tab Yes
24299 @tab @samp{-}
24300 @tab No
24301
24302 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24303 @tab No
24304 @tab @samp{-}
24305 @tab Yes
24306
24307 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24308 @tab No
24309 @tab @samp{-}
24310 @tab Yes
24311
24312 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24313 @tab No
24314 @tab @samp{-}
24315 @tab Yes
24316
24317 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24318 @tab No
24319 @tab @samp{-}
24320 @tab Yes
24321
24322 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24323 @tab No
24324 @tab @samp{-}
24325 @tab Yes
24326
24327 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24328 @tab No
24329 @tab @samp{-}
24330 @tab Yes
24331
24332 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24333 @tab No
24334 @tab @samp{-}
24335 @tab Yes
24336
24337 @end multitable
24338
24339 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24340
24341 @table @samp
24342 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24343 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24344 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24345 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24346 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24347 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24348 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24349 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24350 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24351 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24352
24353 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24354 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24355 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24356
24357 @item qXfer:features:read
24358 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24359 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24360
24361 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24362 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24363 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24364
24365 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24366 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24367 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24368
24369 @item qXfer:spu:read
24370 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24371 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24372
24373 @item qXfer:spu:write
24374 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24375 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24376
24377 @item QPassSignals
24378 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24379 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24380
24381 @end table
24382
24383 @item qSymbol::
24384 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24385 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24386 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24387 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24388
24389 Reply:
24390 @table @samp
24391 @item OK
24392 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24393 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24394 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24395 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24396 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24397 below.
24398 @end table
24399
24400 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24401 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24402
24403 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24404 target has previously requested.
24405
24406 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24407 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24408 will be empty.
24409
24410 Reply:
24411 @table @samp
24412 @item OK
24413 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24414 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24415 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24416 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24417 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24418 @end table
24419
24420 @item QTDP
24421 @itemx QTFrame
24422 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24423
24424 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24425 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24426 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24427 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24428 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24429 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24430 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24431 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24432 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24433 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24434
24435 Reply:
24436 @table @samp
24437 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24438 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24439 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24440 the thread's attributes.
24441 @end table
24442
24443 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24444 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24445 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24446 packets.)
24447
24448 @item QTStart
24449 @itemx QTStop
24450 @itemx QTinit
24451 @itemx QTro
24452 @itemx qTStatus
24453 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24454
24455 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24456 @cindex read special object, remote request
24457 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24458 @anchor{qXfer read}
24459 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24460 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24461 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24462 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24463 additional details about what data to access.
24464
24465 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24466 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24467 formats, listed below.
24468
24469 @table @samp
24470 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24471 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24472 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24473 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24474
24475 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24476 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24477
24478 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24479 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24480 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24481 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24482 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24483
24484 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24485 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24486
24487 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24488 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24489 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24490 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24491 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24492
24493 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24494 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24495 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24496
24497 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24498 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24499
24500 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24501 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24502 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24503 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24504 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24505
24506 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24507 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24508
24509 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24510 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24511 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24512 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24513 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24514 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24515 in that context to be accessed.
24516
24517 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24518 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24519 @end table
24520
24521 Reply:
24522 @table @samp
24523 @item m @var{data}
24524 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24525 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24526 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24527 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24528 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24529 request.
24530
24531 @item l @var{data}
24532 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24533 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24534 than the @var{length} in the request.
24535
24536 @item l
24537 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24538 There is no more data to be read.
24539
24540 @item E00
24541 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24542
24543 @item E @var{nn}
24544 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24545 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24546
24547 @item
24548 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24549 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24550 @end table
24551
24552 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24553 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24554 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24555 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24556 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24557 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24558 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24559 to access.
24560
24561 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24562 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24563 formats, listed below.
24564
24565 @table @samp
24566 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24567 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24568 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24569 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24570 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24571 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24572 in that context to be accessed.
24573
24574 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24575 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24576 @end table
24577
24578 Reply:
24579 @table @samp
24580 @item @var{nn}
24581 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24582 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24583
24584 @item E00
24585 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24586
24587 @item E @var{nn}
24588 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24589 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24590
24591 @item
24592 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24593 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24594 @end table
24595
24596 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24597 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24598 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24599 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24600 must respond with an empty packet.
24601
24602 @end table
24603
24604 @node Register Packet Format
24605 @section Register Packet Format
24606
24607 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24608 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24609 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24610 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24611 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24612 most-significant - least-significant.
24613
24614 @table @r
24615
24616 @item MIPS32
24617
24618 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24619 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24620 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24621
24622 @item MIPS64
24623
24624 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24625 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24626 as @code{MIPS32}.
24627
24628 @end table
24629
24630 @node Tracepoint Packets
24631 @section Tracepoint Packets
24632 @cindex tracepoint packets
24633 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24634
24635 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24636 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24637
24638 @table @samp
24639
24640 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24641 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24642 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24643 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24644 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24645 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24646 tracepoint's actions.
24647
24648 Replies:
24649 @table @samp
24650 @item OK
24651 The packet was understood and carried out.
24652 @item
24653 The packet was not recognized.
24654 @end table
24655
24656 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24657 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24658 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24659 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24660 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24661 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24662 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24663
24664 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24665 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24666 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24667 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24668 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24669 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24670 tracepoint actions.
24671
24672 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24673 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24674 following forms:
24675
24676 @table @samp
24677
24678 @item R @var{mask}
24679 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24680 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24681 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24682 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24683 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24684
24685 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24686 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24687 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24688 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24689 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24690 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24691 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24692
24693 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24694 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24695 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24696 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24697 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24698 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24699 packet).
24700
24701 @end table
24702
24703 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24704 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24705 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24706 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24707 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24708 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24709 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24710 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24711
24712 Replies:
24713 @table @samp
24714 @item OK
24715 The packet was understood and carried out.
24716 @item
24717 The packet was not recognized.
24718 @end table
24719
24720 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24721 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24722 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24723 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24724
24725 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24726 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24727 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24728 one of the following forms:
24729
24730 @table @samp
24731 @item F @var{f}
24732 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24733 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24734 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24735
24736 @item T @var{t}
24737 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24738 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24739
24740 @end table
24741
24742 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24743 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24744 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24745 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24746
24747 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24748 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24749 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24750 is a hexadecimal number.
24751
24752 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24753 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24754 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24755 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24756 numbers.
24757
24758 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24759 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24760 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24761
24762 @item QTStart
24763 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24764 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24765
24766 @item QTStop
24767 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24768
24769 @item QTinit
24770 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24771
24772 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24773 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24774 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24775 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24776
24777 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24778 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24779 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24780 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24781
24782 @item qTStatus
24783 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24784
24785 Replies:
24786 @table @samp
24787 @item T0
24788 There is no trace experiment running.
24789 @item T1
24790 There is a trace experiment running.
24791 @end table
24792
24793 @end table
24794
24795
24796 @node Host I/O Packets
24797 @section Host I/O Packets
24798 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
24799 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
24800
24801 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
24802 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
24803 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
24804 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
24805 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
24806 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
24807 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
24808 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
24809 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
24810 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
24811
24812 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
24813 its arguments. They have this format:
24814
24815 @table @samp
24816
24817 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
24818 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
24819 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
24820 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
24821 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
24822 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
24823 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
24824 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
24825 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24826
24827 @end table
24828
24829 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
24830
24831 @table @samp
24832
24833 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
24834 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
24835 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
24836 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
24837 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
24838 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
24839 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
24840 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
24841 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
24842 @var{attachment}.
24843
24844 @item
24845 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
24846
24847 @end table
24848
24849 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
24850
24851 @table @samp
24852 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
24853 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
24854 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
24855 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
24856 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
24857 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
24858 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
24859
24860 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
24861 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
24862 -1 if an error occurs.
24863
24864 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
24865 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
24866 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
24867 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
24868 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
24869 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
24870 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
24871 @var{count} was zero.
24872
24873 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
24874 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
24875 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
24876 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
24877 some characters were escaped.
24878
24879 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
24880 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
24881 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
24882 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
24883 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
24884 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
24885 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
24886 error occurred.
24887
24888 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
24889 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
24890 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
24891
24892 @end table
24893
24894 @node Interrupts
24895 @section Interrupts
24896 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24897
24898 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24899 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24900 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24901 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24902
24903 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24904 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24905 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24906 interfaces.
24907
24908 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24909 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24910 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24911 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24912 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24913 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24914 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24915 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24916
24917 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24918 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24919 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24920 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24921 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24922 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24923 program is stopped will be discarded.
24924
24925 @node Examples
24926 @section Examples
24927
24928 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24929 does not get any direct output:
24930
24931 @smallexample
24932 -> @code{R00}
24933 <- @code{+}
24934 @emph{target restarts}
24935 -> @code{?}
24936 <- @code{+}
24937 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24938 -> @code{+}
24939 @end smallexample
24940
24941 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24942
24943 @smallexample
24944 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24945 <- @code{+}
24946 -> @code{s}
24947 <- @code{+}
24948 @emph{time passes}
24949 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24950 -> @code{+}
24951 -> @code{g}
24952 <- @code{+}
24953 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24954 -> @code{+}
24955 @end smallexample
24956
24957 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24958 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24959 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24960
24961 @menu
24962 * File-I/O Overview::
24963 * Protocol Basics::
24964 * The F Request Packet::
24965 * The F Reply Packet::
24966 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24967 * Console I/O::
24968 * List of Supported Calls::
24969 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24970 * Constants::
24971 * File-I/O Examples::
24972 @end menu
24973
24974 @node File-I/O Overview
24975 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24976 @cindex file-i/o overview
24977
24978 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24979 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24980 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24981 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24982 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24983 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24984
24985 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24986 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24987 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24988 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24989 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24990
24991 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24992 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24993 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24994 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24995 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24996 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24997 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24998
24999 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25000 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25001 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25002 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25003 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25004
25005 @smallexample
25006 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25007 <- target requests 'system call X'
25008 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25009 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25010 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25011 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25012 @end smallexample
25013
25014 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25015 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25016 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25017 system are not supported by this protocol.
25018
25019 @node Protocol Basics
25020 @subsection Protocol Basics
25021 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25022
25023 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25024 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25025 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25026 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25027 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25028 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25029 to call the appropriate host system call:
25030
25031 @itemize @bullet
25032 @item
25033 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25034
25035 @item
25036 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25037 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25038 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25039 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25040
25041 @end itemize
25042
25043 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25044
25045 @itemize @bullet
25046 @item
25047 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25048 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25049 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25050 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25051 packet.
25052
25053 @item
25054 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25055 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25056
25057 @item
25058 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25059
25060 @item
25061 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25062
25063 @item
25064 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25065 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25066 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25067 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25068 packet.
25069
25070 @end itemize
25071
25072 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25073 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25074
25075 @itemize @bullet
25076 @item
25077 Return value.
25078
25079 @item
25080 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25081
25082 @item
25083 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25084
25085 @end itemize
25086
25087 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25088 the latest continue or step action.
25089
25090 @node The F Request Packet
25091 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25092 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25093 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25094
25095 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25096
25097 @table @samp
25098 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25099
25100 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25101 This is just the name of the function.
25102
25103 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25104 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25105 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25106 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25107 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25108 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25109 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25110
25111 @end table
25112
25113
25114
25115 @node The F Reply Packet
25116 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25117 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25118 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25119
25120 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25121
25122 @table @samp
25123
25124 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25125
25126 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25127
25128 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25129 representation.
25130 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25131
25132 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25133 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25134 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25135
25136 @smallexample
25137 F0,0,C
25138 @end smallexample
25139
25140 @noindent
25141 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25142
25143 @smallexample
25144 F-1,4,C
25145 @end smallexample
25146
25147 @noindent
25148 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25149
25150 @end table
25151
25152
25153 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25154 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25155 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25156
25157 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25158 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25159 the target should behave as if it had
25160 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25161 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25162 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25163 packet.
25164
25165 It's important for the target to know in which
25166 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25167
25168 @itemize @bullet
25169 @item
25170 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25171
25172 @item
25173 The system call on the host has been finished.
25174
25175 @end itemize
25176
25177 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25178 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25179 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25180 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25181 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25182 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25183
25184 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25185 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25186 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25187 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25188 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25189 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25190 or the full action has been completed.
25191
25192 @node Console I/O
25193 @subsection Console I/O
25194 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25195
25196 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25197 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25198 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25199 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25200 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25201 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25202 conditions is met:
25203
25204 @itemize @bullet
25205 @item
25206 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25207 @code{read}
25208 system call is treated as finished.
25209
25210 @item
25211 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25212 newline.
25213
25214 @item
25215 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25216 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25217
25218 @end itemize
25219
25220 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25221 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25222 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25223 is stopped at the user's request.
25224
25225
25226 @node List of Supported Calls
25227 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25228 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25229
25230 @menu
25231 * open::
25232 * close::
25233 * read::
25234 * write::
25235 * lseek::
25236 * rename::
25237 * unlink::
25238 * stat/fstat::
25239 * gettimeofday::
25240 * isatty::
25241 * system::
25242 @end menu
25243
25244 @node open
25245 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25246 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25247
25248 @table @asis
25249 @item Synopsis:
25250 @smallexample
25251 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25252 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25253 @end smallexample
25254
25255 @item Request:
25256 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25257
25258 @noindent
25259 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25260
25261 @table @code
25262 @item O_CREAT
25263 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25264 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25265 are concerned.
25266
25267 @item O_EXCL
25268 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25269 an error and open() fails.
25270
25271 @item O_TRUNC
25272 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25273 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25274 truncated to zero length.
25275
25276 @item O_APPEND
25277 The file is opened in append mode.
25278
25279 @item O_RDONLY
25280 The file is opened for reading only.
25281
25282 @item O_WRONLY
25283 The file is opened for writing only.
25284
25285 @item O_RDWR
25286 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25287 @end table
25288
25289 @noindent
25290 Other bits are silently ignored.
25291
25292
25293 @noindent
25294 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25295
25296 @table @code
25297 @item S_IRUSR
25298 User has read permission.
25299
25300 @item S_IWUSR
25301 User has write permission.
25302
25303 @item S_IRGRP
25304 Group has read permission.
25305
25306 @item S_IWGRP
25307 Group has write permission.
25308
25309 @item S_IROTH
25310 Others have read permission.
25311
25312 @item S_IWOTH
25313 Others have write permission.
25314 @end table
25315
25316 @noindent
25317 Other bits are silently ignored.
25318
25319
25320 @item Return value:
25321 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25322 occurred.
25323
25324 @item Errors:
25325
25326 @table @code
25327 @item EEXIST
25328 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25329
25330 @item EISDIR
25331 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25332
25333 @item EACCES
25334 The requested access is not allowed.
25335
25336 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25337 @var{pathname} was too long.
25338
25339 @item ENOENT
25340 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25341
25342 @item ENODEV
25343 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25344
25345 @item EROFS
25346 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25347 write access was requested.
25348
25349 @item EFAULT
25350 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25351
25352 @item ENOSPC
25353 No space on device to create the file.
25354
25355 @item EMFILE
25356 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25357
25358 @item ENFILE
25359 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25360 has been reached.
25361
25362 @item EINTR
25363 The call was interrupted by the user.
25364 @end table
25365
25366 @end table
25367
25368 @node close
25369 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25370 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25371
25372 @table @asis
25373 @item Synopsis:
25374 @smallexample
25375 int close(int fd);
25376 @end smallexample
25377
25378 @item Request:
25379 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25380
25381 @item Return value:
25382 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25383
25384 @item Errors:
25385
25386 @table @code
25387 @item EBADF
25388 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25389
25390 @item EINTR
25391 The call was interrupted by the user.
25392 @end table
25393
25394 @end table
25395
25396 @node read
25397 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25398 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25399
25400 @table @asis
25401 @item Synopsis:
25402 @smallexample
25403 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25404 @end smallexample
25405
25406 @item Request:
25407 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25408
25409 @item Return value:
25410 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25411 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25412 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25413
25414 @item Errors:
25415
25416 @table @code
25417 @item EBADF
25418 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25419 reading.
25420
25421 @item EFAULT
25422 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25423
25424 @item EINTR
25425 The call was interrupted by the user.
25426 @end table
25427
25428 @end table
25429
25430 @node write
25431 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25432 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25433
25434 @table @asis
25435 @item Synopsis:
25436 @smallexample
25437 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25438 @end smallexample
25439
25440 @item Request:
25441 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25442
25443 @item Return value:
25444 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25445 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25446 is returned.
25447
25448 @item Errors:
25449
25450 @table @code
25451 @item EBADF
25452 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25453 writing.
25454
25455 @item EFAULT
25456 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25457
25458 @item EFBIG
25459 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25460 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25461
25462 @item ENOSPC
25463 No space on device to write the data.
25464
25465 @item EINTR
25466 The call was interrupted by the user.
25467 @end table
25468
25469 @end table
25470
25471 @node lseek
25472 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25473 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25474
25475 @table @asis
25476 @item Synopsis:
25477 @smallexample
25478 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25479 @end smallexample
25480
25481 @item Request:
25482 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25483
25484 @var{flag} is one of:
25485
25486 @table @code
25487 @item SEEK_SET
25488 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25489
25490 @item SEEK_CUR
25491 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25492 bytes.
25493
25494 @item SEEK_END
25495 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25496 bytes.
25497 @end table
25498
25499 @item Return value:
25500 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25501 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25502 value of -1 is returned.
25503
25504 @item Errors:
25505
25506 @table @code
25507 @item EBADF
25508 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25509
25510 @item ESPIPE
25511 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25512
25513 @item EINVAL
25514 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25515
25516 @item EINTR
25517 The call was interrupted by the user.
25518 @end table
25519
25520 @end table
25521
25522 @node rename
25523 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25524 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25525
25526 @table @asis
25527 @item Synopsis:
25528 @smallexample
25529 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25530 @end smallexample
25531
25532 @item Request:
25533 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25534
25535 @item Return value:
25536 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25537
25538 @item Errors:
25539
25540 @table @code
25541 @item EISDIR
25542 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25543 directory.
25544
25545 @item EEXIST
25546 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25547
25548 @item EBUSY
25549 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25550 process.
25551
25552 @item EINVAL
25553 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25554 of itself.
25555
25556 @item ENOTDIR
25557 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25558 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25559 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25560
25561 @item EFAULT
25562 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25563
25564 @item EACCES
25565 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25566
25567 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25568
25569 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25570
25571 @item ENOENT
25572 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25573
25574 @item EROFS
25575 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25576
25577 @item ENOSPC
25578 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25579 directory entry.
25580
25581 @item EINTR
25582 The call was interrupted by the user.
25583 @end table
25584
25585 @end table
25586
25587 @node unlink
25588 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25589 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25590
25591 @table @asis
25592 @item Synopsis:
25593 @smallexample
25594 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25595 @end smallexample
25596
25597 @item Request:
25598 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25599
25600 @item Return value:
25601 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25602
25603 @item Errors:
25604
25605 @table @code
25606 @item EACCES
25607 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25608
25609 @item EPERM
25610 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25611
25612 @item EBUSY
25613 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25614 being used by another process.
25615
25616 @item EFAULT
25617 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25618
25619 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25620 @var{pathname} was too long.
25621
25622 @item ENOENT
25623 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25624
25625 @item ENOTDIR
25626 A component of the path is not a directory.
25627
25628 @item EROFS
25629 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25630
25631 @item EINTR
25632 The call was interrupted by the user.
25633 @end table
25634
25635 @end table
25636
25637 @node stat/fstat
25638 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25639 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25640 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25641
25642 @table @asis
25643 @item Synopsis:
25644 @smallexample
25645 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25646 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25647 @end smallexample
25648
25649 @item Request:
25650 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25651 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25652
25653 @item Return value:
25654 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25655
25656 @item Errors:
25657
25658 @table @code
25659 @item EBADF
25660 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25661
25662 @item ENOENT
25663 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25664 path is an empty string.
25665
25666 @item ENOTDIR
25667 A component of the path is not a directory.
25668
25669 @item EFAULT
25670 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25671
25672 @item EACCES
25673 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25674
25675 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25676 @var{pathname} was too long.
25677
25678 @item EINTR
25679 The call was interrupted by the user.
25680 @end table
25681
25682 @end table
25683
25684 @node gettimeofday
25685 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25686 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25687
25688 @table @asis
25689 @item Synopsis:
25690 @smallexample
25691 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25692 @end smallexample
25693
25694 @item Request:
25695 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25696
25697 @item Return value:
25698 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25699
25700 @item Errors:
25701
25702 @table @code
25703 @item EINVAL
25704 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25705
25706 @item EFAULT
25707 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25708 @end table
25709
25710 @end table
25711
25712 @node isatty
25713 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25714 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25715
25716 @table @asis
25717 @item Synopsis:
25718 @smallexample
25719 int isatty(int fd);
25720 @end smallexample
25721
25722 @item Request:
25723 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25724
25725 @item Return value:
25726 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25727
25728 @item Errors:
25729
25730 @table @code
25731 @item EINTR
25732 The call was interrupted by the user.
25733 @end table
25734
25735 @end table
25736
25737 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25738 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25739 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25740 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25741 needed.
25742
25743
25744 @node system
25745 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25746 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25747
25748 @table @asis
25749 @item Synopsis:
25750 @smallexample
25751 int system(const char *command);
25752 @end smallexample
25753
25754 @item Request:
25755 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25756
25757 @item Return value:
25758 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25759 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25760 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25761 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25762 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25763 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25764 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25765
25766 @item Errors:
25767
25768 @table @code
25769 @item EINTR
25770 The call was interrupted by the user.
25771 @end table
25772
25773 @end table
25774
25775 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25776 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25777 the host is simplified before it's returned
25778 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25779 is discarded, and the return value consists
25780 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25781
25782 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25783 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25784 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25785
25786 @table @code
25787 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25788 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25789 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25790 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25791
25792 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25793 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25794 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25795 protocol.
25796 @end table
25797
25798 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25799 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25800 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25801
25802 @menu
25803 * Integral Datatypes::
25804 * Pointer Values::
25805 * Memory Transfer::
25806 * struct stat::
25807 * struct timeval::
25808 @end menu
25809
25810 @node Integral Datatypes
25811 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25812 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25813
25814 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25815 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25816 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25817
25818 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25819 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25820
25821 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25822
25823 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25824 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25825
25826 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25827
25828 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25829 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25830 byte order.
25831
25832 @node Pointer Values
25833 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25834 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25835
25836 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25837 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25838 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25839 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25840
25841 @smallexample
25842 @code{1aaf/12}
25843 @end smallexample
25844
25845 @noindent
25846 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25847 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25848 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25849 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25850
25851 @smallexample
25852 @code{123456/d}
25853 @end smallexample
25854
25855 @node Memory Transfer
25856 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25857 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25858
25859 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25860 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25861 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25862 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25863 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25864 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25865 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25866
25867
25868 @node struct stat
25869 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25870 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25871
25872 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25873 is defined as follows:
25874
25875 @smallexample
25876 struct stat @{
25877 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25878 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25879 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25880 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25881 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25882 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25883 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25884 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25885 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25886 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25887 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25888 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25889 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25890 @};
25891 @end smallexample
25892
25893 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25894 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25895 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25896
25897 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25898 range of values.
25899
25900 @table @code
25901
25902 @item st_dev
25903 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25904
25905 @item st_ino
25906 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25907
25908 @item st_mode
25909 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25910 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25911
25912 @item st_uid
25913 @itemx st_gid
25914 @itemx st_rdev
25915 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25916
25917 @item st_atime
25918 @itemx st_mtime
25919 @itemx st_ctime
25920 These values have a host and file system dependent
25921 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25922 support exact timing values.
25923 @end table
25924
25925 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25926 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25927 continuing.
25928
25929 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25930 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25931 get truncated on the target.
25932
25933 @node struct timeval
25934 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25935 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25936
25937 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25938 is defined as follows:
25939
25940 @smallexample
25941 struct timeval @{
25942 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25943 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25944 @};
25945 @end smallexample
25946
25947 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25948 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25949 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25950
25951 @node Constants
25952 @subsection Constants
25953 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25954
25955 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25956 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25957 values before and after the call as needed.
25958
25959 @menu
25960 * Open Flags::
25961 * mode_t Values::
25962 * Errno Values::
25963 * Lseek Flags::
25964 * Limits::
25965 @end menu
25966
25967 @node Open Flags
25968 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25969 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25970
25971 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25972
25973 @smallexample
25974 O_RDONLY 0x0
25975 O_WRONLY 0x1
25976 O_RDWR 0x2
25977 O_APPEND 0x8
25978 O_CREAT 0x200
25979 O_TRUNC 0x400
25980 O_EXCL 0x800
25981 @end smallexample
25982
25983 @node mode_t Values
25984 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25985 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25986
25987 All values are given in octal representation.
25988
25989 @smallexample
25990 S_IFREG 0100000
25991 S_IFDIR 040000
25992 S_IRUSR 0400
25993 S_IWUSR 0200
25994 S_IXUSR 0100
25995 S_IRGRP 040
25996 S_IWGRP 020
25997 S_IXGRP 010
25998 S_IROTH 04
25999 S_IWOTH 02
26000 S_IXOTH 01
26001 @end smallexample
26002
26003 @node Errno Values
26004 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26005 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26006
26007 All values are given in decimal representation.
26008
26009 @smallexample
26010 EPERM 1
26011 ENOENT 2
26012 EINTR 4
26013 EBADF 9
26014 EACCES 13
26015 EFAULT 14
26016 EBUSY 16
26017 EEXIST 17
26018 ENODEV 19
26019 ENOTDIR 20
26020 EISDIR 21
26021 EINVAL 22
26022 ENFILE 23
26023 EMFILE 24
26024 EFBIG 27
26025 ENOSPC 28
26026 ESPIPE 29
26027 EROFS 30
26028 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26029 EUNKNOWN 9999
26030 @end smallexample
26031
26032 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26033 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26034
26035 @node Lseek Flags
26036 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26037 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26038
26039 @smallexample
26040 SEEK_SET 0
26041 SEEK_CUR 1
26042 SEEK_END 2
26043 @end smallexample
26044
26045 @node Limits
26046 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26047 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26048
26049 All values are given in decimal representation.
26050
26051 @smallexample
26052 INT_MIN -2147483648
26053 INT_MAX 2147483647
26054 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26055 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26056 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26057 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26058 @end smallexample
26059
26060 @node File-I/O Examples
26061 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26062 @cindex file-i/o examples
26063
26064 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26065 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26066
26067 @smallexample
26068 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26069 @emph{request memory read from target}
26070 -> @code{m1234,6}
26071 <- XXXXXX
26072 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26073 -> @code{F6}
26074 @end smallexample
26075
26076 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26077 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26078
26079 @smallexample
26080 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26081 @emph{request memory write to target}
26082 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26083 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26084 -> @code{F6}
26085 @end smallexample
26086
26087 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26088 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26089
26090 @smallexample
26091 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26092 -> @code{F-1,9}
26093 @end smallexample
26094
26095 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26096 host is called:
26097
26098 @smallexample
26099 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26100 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26101 <- @code{T02}
26102 @end smallexample
26103
26104 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26105 host is called:
26106
26107 @smallexample
26108 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26109 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26110 <- @code{T02}
26111 @end smallexample
26112
26113 @node Library List Format
26114 @section Library List Format
26115 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26116
26117 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26118 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26119 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26120 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26121 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26122 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26123 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26124 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26125 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26126 are loaded.
26127
26128 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26129 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26130 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
26131 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
26132 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
26133 link-time base addresses.
26134
26135 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26136 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26137
26138 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26139 offset, looks like this:
26140
26141 @smallexample
26142 <library-list>
26143 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26144 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26145 </library>
26146 </library-list>
26147 @end smallexample
26148
26149 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26150
26151 @smallexample
26152 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26153 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26154 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26155 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
26156 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26157 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26158 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26159 @end smallexample
26160
26161 @node Memory Map Format
26162 @section Memory Map Format
26163 @cindex memory map format
26164
26165 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26166 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26167 memory map.
26168
26169 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26170 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26171 lists memory regions.
26172
26173 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26174 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26175
26176 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26177
26178 @smallexample
26179 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26180 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26181 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26182 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26183 <memory-map>
26184 region...
26185 </memory-map>
26186 @end smallexample
26187
26188 Each region can be either:
26189
26190 @itemize
26191
26192 @item
26193 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26194 bytes from there:
26195
26196 @smallexample
26197 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26198 @end smallexample
26199
26200
26201 @item
26202 A region of read-only memory:
26203
26204 @smallexample
26205 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26206 @end smallexample
26207
26208
26209 @item
26210 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26211 bytes in length:
26212
26213 @smallexample
26214 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26215 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26216 </memory>
26217 @end smallexample
26218
26219 @end itemize
26220
26221 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26222 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26223 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26224
26225 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26226
26227 @smallexample
26228 <!-- ................................................... -->
26229 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26230 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26231 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26232 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26233 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26234 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26235 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26236 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26237 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26238 and its type, or device. -->
26239 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26240 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26241 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26242 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26243 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26244 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26245 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26246 @end smallexample
26247
26248 @include agentexpr.texi
26249
26250 @node Target Descriptions
26251 @appendix Target Descriptions
26252 @cindex target descriptions
26253
26254 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26255 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26256 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26257
26258 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26259 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26260 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26261 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26262 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26263 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26264 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26265
26266 @itemize @bullet
26267 @item
26268 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26269 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26270 @item
26271 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26272 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26273 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26274 @item
26275 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26276 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26277 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26278 @end itemize
26279
26280 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26281 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26282 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26283 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26284 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26285
26286 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26287 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26288
26289 @menu
26290 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26291 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26292 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26293 descriptions.
26294 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26295 @end menu
26296
26297 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26298 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26299
26300 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26301 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26302 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26303 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26304 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26305 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26306 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26307 Format}.
26308
26309 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26310 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26311 specify a file are:
26312
26313 @table @code
26314 @cindex set tdesc filename
26315 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26316 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26317
26318 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26319 @item unset tdesc filename
26320 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26321 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26322
26323 @cindex show tdesc filename
26324 @item show tdesc filename
26325 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26326 @end table
26327
26328
26329 @node Target Description Format
26330 @section Target Description Format
26331 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26332
26333 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26334 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26335 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26336 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26337 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26338 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26339 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26340
26341 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26342 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26343 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26344 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26345
26346 Here is a simple target description:
26347
26348 @smallexample
26349 <target version="1.0">
26350 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26351 </target>
26352 @end smallexample
26353
26354 @noindent
26355 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26356 the x86-64 architecture.
26357
26358 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26359 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26360 are explained further below.
26361
26362 @smallexample
26363 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26364 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26365 <target version="1.0">
26366 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26367 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26368 </target>
26369 @end smallexample
26370
26371 @noindent
26372 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26373 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26374 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26375 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26376 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26377 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26378 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26379 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26380 the version mismatch.
26381
26382 @subsection Inclusion
26383 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26384 @cindex XInclude
26385 @ifnotinfo
26386 @cindex <xi:include>
26387 @end ifnotinfo
26388
26389 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26390 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26391 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26392 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26393 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26394
26395 @smallexample
26396 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26397 @end smallexample
26398
26399 @noindent
26400 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26401 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26402 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26403 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26404 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26405 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26406 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26407 original description.
26408
26409 @subsection Architecture
26410 @cindex <architecture>
26411
26412 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26413
26414 @smallexample
26415 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26416 @end smallexample
26417
26418 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26419 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26420 Debugging Target}).
26421
26422 @subsection Features
26423 @cindex <feature>
26424
26425 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26426 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26427 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26428 has this form:
26429
26430 @smallexample
26431 <feature name="@var{name}">
26432 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26433 @var{reg}@dots{}
26434 </feature>
26435 @end smallexample
26436
26437 @noindent
26438 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26439 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26440 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26441 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26442
26443 @subsection Types
26444
26445 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26446 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26447 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26448 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26449 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26450
26451 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26452 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26453 Types must be defined before they are used.
26454
26455 @cindex <vector>
26456 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26457 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26458 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26459 @var{count}:
26460
26461 @smallexample
26462 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26463 @end smallexample
26464
26465 @cindex <union>
26466 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26467 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26468 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26469 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26470
26471 @smallexample
26472 <union id="@var{id}">
26473 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26474 @dots{}
26475 </union>
26476 @end smallexample
26477
26478 @subsection Registers
26479 @cindex <reg>
26480
26481 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26482
26483 @smallexample
26484 <reg name="@var{name}"
26485 bitsize="@var{size}"
26486 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26487 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26488 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26489 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26490 @end smallexample
26491
26492 @noindent
26493 The components are as follows:
26494
26495 @table @var
26496
26497 @item name
26498 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26499
26500 @item bitsize
26501 The register's size, in bits.
26502
26503 @item regnum
26504 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26505 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26506 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26507 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26508 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26509 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26510 in order of increasing register number.
26511
26512 @item save-restore
26513 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26514 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26515 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26516 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26517 ABI.
26518
26519 @item type
26520 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26521 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26522 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26523 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26524 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26525 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26526
26527 @item group
26528 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26529 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26530 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26531 in @code{info registers}.
26532
26533 @end table
26534
26535 @node Predefined Target Types
26536 @section Predefined Target Types
26537 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26538
26539 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26540 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26541 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26542 types. The currently supported types are:
26543
26544 @table @code
26545
26546 @item int8
26547 @itemx int16
26548 @itemx int32
26549 @itemx int64
26550 @itemx int128
26551 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26552
26553 @item uint8
26554 @itemx uint16
26555 @itemx uint32
26556 @itemx uint64
26557 @itemx uint128
26558 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26559
26560 @item code_ptr
26561 @itemx data_ptr
26562 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26563 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26564 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26565 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26566 may be marked as data pointers.
26567
26568 @item ieee_single
26569 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26570
26571 @item ieee_double
26572 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26573
26574 @item arm_fpa_ext
26575 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26576
26577 @end table
26578
26579 @node Standard Target Features
26580 @section Standard Target Features
26581 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26582
26583 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26584 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26585 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26586 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26587 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26588 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26589 can recognize them.
26590
26591 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26592 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26593 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26594 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26595 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26596 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26597 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26598 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26599
26600 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26601 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26602 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26603
26604 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26605 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26606 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26607 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26608
26609 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26610 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26611 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26612
26613 @menu
26614 * ARM Features::
26615 * M68K Features::
26616 @end menu
26617
26618
26619 @node ARM Features
26620 @subsection ARM Features
26621 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26622
26623 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26624 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26625 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26626
26627 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26628 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26629
26630 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26631 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26632 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26633 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26634
26635 @subsection MIPS Features
26636 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26637
26638 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26639 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26640 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26641 on the target.
26642
26643 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26644 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26645 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26646
26647 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26648 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26649 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26650 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26651
26652 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26653 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26654 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26655
26656 @node M68K Features
26657 @subsection M68K Features
26658 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26659
26660 @table @code
26661 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26662 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26663 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26664 One of those features must be always present.
26665 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26666 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26667 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26668 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26669
26670 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26671 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26672 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26673 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26674 @end table
26675
26676 @subsection PowerPC Features
26677 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26678
26679 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26680 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26681 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26682 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26683
26684 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26685 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26686
26687 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26688 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26689 and @samp{vrsave}.
26690
26691 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26692 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26693 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26694 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26695 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26696 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26697 user.
26698
26699 @include gpl.texi
26700
26701 @raisesections
26702 @include fdl.texi
26703 @lowersections
26704
26705 @node Index
26706 @unnumbered Index
26707
26708 @printindex cp
26709
26710 @tex
26711 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26712 % meantime:
26713 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26714 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26715 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26716 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26717 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26718 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26719 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26720 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26721 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26722 \page\colophon
26723 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26724 @end tex
26725
26726 @bye
This page took 1.182163 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.